blob: 9d4aa2223cb20fe5d0147fe4b8c2e8735f33519b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1a38ffc2020-11-21 16:00:40 +01007 2020/11/21
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
408 - the running process' environment, in case some environment variables are
409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100840 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200841 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200843 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200844 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200846 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847 - presetenv
848 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - uid
850 - ulimit-n
851 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200852 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100853 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200854 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200855 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-options
859 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-options
862 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100863 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200864 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100865 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100866 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100867 - 51degrees-data-file
868 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200869 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200870 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200871 - wurfl-data-file
872 - wurfl-information-list
873 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200874 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100875 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100878 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200879 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200881 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100882 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100883 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100884 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200885 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200886 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200887 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200888 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - noepoll
890 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000891 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100893 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300894 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000895 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100896 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200898 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200899 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000900 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000901 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200902 - tune.buffers.limit
903 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200904 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200905 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100906 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200907 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200908 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200909 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200910 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100911 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200912 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200913 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200914 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100916 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100917 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100918 - tune.lua.session-timeout
919 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200920 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100921 - tune.maxaccept
922 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200923 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200924 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200925 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200926 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
927 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100928 - tune.rcvbuf.client
929 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100930 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200931 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200932 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100933 - tune.sndbuf.client
934 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100935 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200936 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100937 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200938 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100939 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200940 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200941 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100942 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200943 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100944 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200945 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
946 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
947 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100948 - tune.zlib.memlevel
949 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200953 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957------------------------------------
958
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959ca-base <dir>
960 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100961 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
962 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
963 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965chroot <jail dir>
966 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
967 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
968 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
969 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
970 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100972
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100973cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
974 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
975 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
976 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
977 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
978 set. These sets have the format
979
980 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
981
982 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100983 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100984 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
985 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100986 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
987 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100989 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100990 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100992 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
993 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
994 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
995 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100996
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
998 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
999 on the machine's word size.
1000
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001001 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001002 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1003 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1004 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1005 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1006 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1007 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001008
1009 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001010 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1011
1012 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1013 # first 4 CPUs
1014
1015 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1016 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1017 # word size.
1018
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001019 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001020 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001021 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1024
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001025 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1026 # and so on.
1027 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001032 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1033 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1034 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1035
1036 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1037 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1038 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1039
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001040 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1041 # and a thread range.
1042 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1043 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1045
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001046crt-base <dir>
1047 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001048 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1049 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051daemon
1052 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1053 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001054 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1055 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001057deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1058 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001059 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001060
1061deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001063 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1064
1065deviceatlas-separator <char>
1066 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1067 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1068
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001069deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001070 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1071 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1072 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001074external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1076 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001077 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1078 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1079 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1080 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1081 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083gid <number>
1084 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
1085 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1086 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001087 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1088 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001090
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001091group <group name>
1092 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1093 See also "gid" and "user".
1094
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001095hard-stop-after <time>
1096 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1097
1098 Arguments :
1099 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1100 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1101 SIGUSR1 signal.
1102
1103 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1104 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1105 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
1109 hard-stop-after 30s
1110
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001111h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1112 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1113 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1114 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1115 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001116 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001117 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1118 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1119 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1120 specified in a proxy.
1121
1122 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1123 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1124 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1125 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1126 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1127 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1128 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1129
1130 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1131 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1132 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1133 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1134 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1135
1136 Example:
1137 global
1138 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1139
1140 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1141 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1142
1143h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1144 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1145 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1146 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1147 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1148 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1149 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1150 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1151 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1152
1153 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1154 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1155 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1156
1157 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1158 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1159
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001160insecure-fork-wanted
1161 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1162 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1163 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1164 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1165 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1166 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1167 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1168 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1169 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1170 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1171 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1172 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1173 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1174 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1175 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1176 disable it.
1177
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001178insecure-setuid-wanted
1179 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1180 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1181 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1182 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1183 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1184 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1185 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1186 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1187 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1188 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1189 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1190 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1191 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1192 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1193
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001194issuers-chain-path <dir>
1195 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1196 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1197 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1198 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1199 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1200 "issuers-chain-path".
1201 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1202 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1203 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1204 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1205 will share the chain in memory.
1206
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001207localpeer <name>
1208 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1209 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1210 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1211 the configuration parsing.
1212
1213 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1214 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1215
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
1217 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001218 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001220 configured with "log global".
1221
1222 <address> can be one of:
1223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001225 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1226 port).
1227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001232 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1234 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001235 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1238 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1239 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1240 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1241 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1242 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1243 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1244 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1245 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1246 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1247 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1248 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1249 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1250 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001251 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1252 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001253
1254 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1255 "fd@2", see above.
1256
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001257 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1258 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1259 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1260 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1261 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1262
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1264 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001265
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001266 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1267 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1268 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1269 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1270 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1271 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1272 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1273 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1274 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1275 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1277 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001278
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001279 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1280 one of the following :
1281
1282 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1283 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1284
1285 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1286 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1287
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001288 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1289 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1290 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1291 designed to be used with a local log server.
1292
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001293 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1294 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1295 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1296 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1297 logger consumes.
1298
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001299 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1300 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1301 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1302 used with a local log server.
1303
1304 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1305 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1306 designed to be used with a local log server.
1307
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001308 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1309 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1310 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1311 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1312
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001313 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1314 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1315 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1316 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1317 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1318
1319 <sample_size>
1320 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1321 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1322 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1323 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1324 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1325
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001326 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001328 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1329 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1330 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1331
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001332 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1333 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1334 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1335 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001336
1337 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001338 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1339 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1340 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1341 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1342 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1343 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001344
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001345 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001346
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001347log-send-hostname [<string>]
1348 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1349 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1350 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1351 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1352 the logs.
1353
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001354log-tag <string>
1355 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1356 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1357 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001358 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001359
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001360lua-load <file>
1361 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1362 used multiple times.
1363
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001364lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1365 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1366 variable.
1367 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1368 to "path".
1369
1370 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1371 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1372 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1373 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1374 will be checked earlier.
1375
1376 As an example by specifying the following path:
1377
1378 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1379 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1380
1381 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1382 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1383 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1384 paths if that does not exist either.
1385
1386 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1387 documentation.
1388
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001389master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001390 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1391 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1392 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001393 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001394 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1395 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001396 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1397 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1398 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1399 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1400 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001401
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001402 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001403
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001404mworker-max-reloads <number>
1405 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001406 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001407 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1408 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1409 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1410
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001411nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1413 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1414 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001415 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1416 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001417 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1418 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1419 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001420
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001421nbthread <number>
1422 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001423 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1424 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1425 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1426 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1427 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001428 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1429 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1430 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1431 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1432 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1433 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1434 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001435
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001437 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1438 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1439 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1440 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001442pp2-never-send-local
1443 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1444 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1445 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1446 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1447 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1448 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1449 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1450 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1451 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1452 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1453 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1454
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001455presetenv <name> <value>
1456 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1457 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1458 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1459 and "unsetenv".
1460
1461resetenv [<name> ...]
1462 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1463 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1464 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1465 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1466 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1467 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1468 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1469 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1470
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001471stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001472 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1473 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1474 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1475 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1476 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1477 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001478 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001479 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1480 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1481 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1482 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001483
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001484server-state-base <directory>
1485 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001486 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1487 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001488
1489server-state-file <file>
1490 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1491 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1492 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1493 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1494 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1495 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1496 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1497 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001498 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1499 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001500
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001501setenv <name> <value>
1502 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1503 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1504 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1505 and "unsetenv".
1506
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001507set-dumpable
1508 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001509 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1510 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1511 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1512 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1513 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1514 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1515 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1516 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1517 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1518 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1519 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1520 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1521 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1522 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1523 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1524 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1525 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001526
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001527ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1529 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001530 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001531 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001532 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1533 information and recommendations see e.g.
1534 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1535 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1536 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1537 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001538
1539ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1541 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1542 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1543 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1544 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001545 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1546 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1547 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001548 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001549
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001550ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1552 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1553 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1554 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1555 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1556
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001557ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1559 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1560 keyword to see available options.
1561
1562 Example:
1563 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001564 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001565
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001566ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1568 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001569 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001570 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001571 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1572 information and recommendations see e.g.
1573 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1574 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1575 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1576 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1577 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001578
1579ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1581 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1582 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1583 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1584 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001585 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1586 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1587 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1588 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001589
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001590ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1592 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1593 keyword to see available options.
1594
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001595ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1597 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1598 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001599 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001600 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001601 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1602 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1603 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1604 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001605 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1606 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1607 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1608
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001609ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1610 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1611 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001612 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001613 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001614 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1615
1616 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001617
1618 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1619 and won't try to remove them.
1620
1621 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1622
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001623ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001624 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001625 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1626 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001627
1628 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1629 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1630 optimize the startup time.
1631
1632 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1633 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1634 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1635
1636 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001637 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001638
1639 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001640 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1641
1642 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1643 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1644 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1645 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1646 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1647 bind configuration..
1648
1649 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1650 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1651 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1652 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1653 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1654 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1655 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1656 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1657
1658 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1659
1660 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1661 a cert bundle.
1662
1663 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1664 separately in several "crt".
1665
1666 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1667 since files are loading separately.
1668
1669 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1670 required to commit them.
1671
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001672 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001673 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001674
1675 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1676
1677 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1678
1679 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1680 not provided in the PEM file.
1681
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001682 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1683 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1684
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001685 The default behavior is "all".
1686
1687 Example:
1688 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1689 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1690 ssl-load-extra-files none
1691
1692 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1693
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001694ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1695 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1696 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1697 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1698
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001699ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001700 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001701 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1702 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1703 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1704 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1705 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1706 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001707 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001708
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001709stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1710 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1711 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1712 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001713 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001714 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001715
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001716 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1717 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1718 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001719
1720stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1721 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1722 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001723 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001724
1725stats maxconn <connections>
1726 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1727 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729uid <number>
1730 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1731 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1732 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1733 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1734
1735ulimit-n <number>
1736 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1737 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1738 option.
1739
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001740unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1741 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1742
1743 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1744 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1745 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1746 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1747 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1748 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1749 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1750 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1751 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1752 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1753
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001754unsetenv [<name> ...]
1755 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1756 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1757 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1758 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1759 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1760 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1761 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1762
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001763user <user name>
1764 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1765 See also "uid" and "group".
1766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001767node <name>
1768 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1769
1770 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1771 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1772 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1773 traffic.
1774
1775description <text>
1776 Add a text that describes the instance.
1777
1778 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1779 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1780 "<" and ">" characters.
1781
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100178251degrees-data-file <file path>
1783 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001785
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001786 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001787 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1788
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000178951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001790 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1791 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1792 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1793
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001794 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001795 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1796
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200179751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001798 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1799 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1800
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001801 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1802 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1803
180451degrees-cache-size <number>
1805 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1806 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1807 By default, this cache is disabled.
1808
1809 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001810 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1811
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001812wurfl-data-file <file path>
1813 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1814 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1815
1816 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1817 with USE_WURFL=1.
1818
1819wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1820 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1821 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1822 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1823
1824 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1825
1826 Valid WURFL properties are:
1827 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1828
1829 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1830 device.
1831
1832 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1833 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1834
1835 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1836 particular web request.
1837
1838 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1839 used Libwurfl API version.
1840
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001841 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1842 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1843
1844 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1845 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1846
1847 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1848
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001849 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1850 with USE_WURFL=1.
1851
1852wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1853 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1854 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1855
1856 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1857 with USE_WURFL=1.
1858
1859wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1860 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1861 thus before the chroot.
1862
1863 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1864 with USE_WURFL=1.
1865
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001866wurfl-cache-size <size>
1867 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1868 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001869 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001870 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001871
1872 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1873 with USE_WURFL=1.
1874
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001875strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001876 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1877 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1878 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1879 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1880 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018823.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001883-----------------------
1884
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001885busy-polling
1886 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1887 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1888 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1889 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1890 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1891 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1892 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1893 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1894 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1895 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1896 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1897 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1898 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1899 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1900 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1901 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1902 "poll" pollers.
1903
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001904 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1905 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1906 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1907
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001908max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1909 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1910 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1911 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1912 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1913 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1914 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1915 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1916 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1917
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001918maxconn <number>
1919 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1920 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1921 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001922 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1923 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1924 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1925 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001926 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1927 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1928 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1929 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1930 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1931 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001932
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001933maxconnrate <number>
1934 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1935 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1936 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1937 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1938 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1939 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1940 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1941 fairness.
1942
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001943maxcomprate <number>
1944 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001946 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1947 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1948 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001949 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001950 default value.
1951
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001952maxcompcpuusage <number>
1953 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1954 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1955 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1956 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1957 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1958 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1959 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1960 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1961
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001962maxpipes <number>
1963 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1964 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1965 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1966 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1967 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1968 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1969
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001970maxsessrate <number>
1971 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1972 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1973 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1974 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1975 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1976 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1977 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1978 fairness.
1979
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001980maxsslconn <number>
1981 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1982 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1983 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1984 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1985 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1986 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1987 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001988 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1989 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1990 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1991 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1992 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1993 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1994 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001995
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001996maxsslrate <number>
1997 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1998 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1999 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2000 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2001 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2002 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2003 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2004 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2005 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2006 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2007
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002008maxzlibmem <number>
2009 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2010 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2011 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002012 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2013 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2014 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2015
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016noepoll
2017 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2018 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002019 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002020
2021nokqueue
2022 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2025
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002026noevports
2027 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2028 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2029 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2030 also "nopoll".
2031
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002032nopoll
2033 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2034 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002036 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2037 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002038
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002039nosplice
2040 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002041 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002042 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002043 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002044 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2045 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2046 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2047 "option splice-response".
2048
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002049nogetaddrinfo
2050 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2051 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2052
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002053noreuseport
2054 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2055 command line argument "-dR".
2056
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002057profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2058 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2059 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2060 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2061 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002062 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002063 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2064 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2065 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2066 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2067
2068 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2069 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2070 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2071 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2072 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002073 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2074 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2075 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2076 CLI.
2077
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002078spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002079 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2080 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2081 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2082 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2083 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2084 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002085
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002087 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002088 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002089 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2090 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2091 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2092 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2093 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002094 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2095 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002096 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2097 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2098 openssl configuration file uses:
2099 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2100
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002101ssl-mode-async
2102 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002103 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002104 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2105 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2106 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002107 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002108 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002109
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002110tune.buffers.limit <number>
2111 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2112 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2113 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2114 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2115 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002116 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002117 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2118 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2119 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2120 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2121 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2122 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2123 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2124 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2125 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2126
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002127tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2128 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2129 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2130 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2131 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2132
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002133tune.bufsize <number>
2134 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2135 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2136 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2137 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2138 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2139 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2140 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002141 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2142 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2143 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002144 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002145 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2146 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2147 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002148
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002149tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2150 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002151
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002152tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2153 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2154 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2155 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2156 this value. The default value is 1.
2157
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002158tune.fail-alloc
2159 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2160 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2161 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2162 gracefully.
2163
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002164tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2165 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2166 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2167 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2168 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2169 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2170
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002171tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2172 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2173 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2174 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2175 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2176 change it.
2177
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002178tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2179 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002180 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2181 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002182 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2183 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2184 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2185 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2186 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2187
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002188tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2189 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2190 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2191 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2192 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2193 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2194 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2195 recommended not to change this value.
2196
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002197tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2198 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2199 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2200 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2201 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2202 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2203 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2204 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2205
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002206tune.http.cookielen <number>
2207 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2208 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2209 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2210 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2211 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2212 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2213 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2214 to change this value.
2215
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002216tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002217 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2218 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002219 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002220 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002221 configuration directives too.
2222 The default value is 1024.
2223
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002224tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2225 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2226 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2227 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2228 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2229 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2230 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002231 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2232 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2233 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002234
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002235tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2236 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2237 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2238 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2239 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2240 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2241 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2242 this option to "off". The default is on.
2243
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002244tune.idletimer <timeout>
2245 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2246 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2247 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2248 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2249 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2250 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002251 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002252 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002253 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2254
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002255tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2256 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2257 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2258 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2259 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2260 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2261 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2262 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2263 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2264 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2265
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002266tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2267 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002268 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002269 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2270 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002271 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002272 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2273 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2274
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002275tune.lua.maxmem
2276 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2277 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2278 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2279 memory.
2280
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002281tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2282 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002283 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2284 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002285 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002286
2287tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2288 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2289 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2290 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2291 check servers.
2292
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002293tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2294 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2295 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2296 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002297 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002298
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002299tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002300 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2301 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2302 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2303 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2304 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2305 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2306 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2307 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2308 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2309 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002310
2311tune.maxpollevents <number>
2312 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2313 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2314 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2315 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2316 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2317
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002318tune.maxrewrite <number>
2319 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2320 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2321 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2322 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2323 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2324 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2325 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2326 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2327 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2328 bufsize.
2329
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002330tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2331 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2332 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2333 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2334 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2335 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2336 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2337 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2338 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2339 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002340 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2341 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002342 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2343 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2344 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2345 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2346 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2347 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2348 setting this parameter to 0.
2349
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002350tune.pipesize <number>
2351 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2352 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2353 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2354 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2355 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2356 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2357
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002358tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2359 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2360 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2361 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2362 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2363 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2364 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002365 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002366
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002367tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2368 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2369 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2370 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2371 default is 20.
2372
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002373tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2374tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2375 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2376 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2377 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002379 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002380 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2381 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2382
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002383tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002384 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002385 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2386 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2387 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2388 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2389
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002390tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002391 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002392 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002393 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2394 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2395 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2396
2397tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2398 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2399 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2400 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2401 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2402 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2403 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2404 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2405 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2406 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002407
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002408tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2409tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2410 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2411 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2412 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002413 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002414 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002415 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2416 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2417 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2418 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2419 notifying haproxy again.
2420
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002421tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002422 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2423 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2424 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002425 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002426 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002427 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002428 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2429 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2430 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002431 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2432 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002433
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002434tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002435 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002436 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2437 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2438 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2439 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2440 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2441
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002442tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2443 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2444 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2445 performances. This is disabled by default.
2446
2447 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2448 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2449
2450 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2451
2452 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2453
2454 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2455
2456 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2457 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2458 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2459
2460 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2461 converted.
2462
2463 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2464 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2465 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2466 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2467 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2468 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2469 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002470 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2471 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002472
2473 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2474
2475 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2476 only need this line:
2477
2478 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2479
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002480tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2481 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002482 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002483 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2484 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2485 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2486 being used for too long.
2487
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002488tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2489 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2490 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2491 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2492 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2493 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2494 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2495 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2496 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2497 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2498 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002499 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002500 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002501
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002502tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2503 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2504 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2505 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2506 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002507 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002508 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2509 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002510 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2511 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002512
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002513tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2514 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2515 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2516 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2517 1000 entries.
2518
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002519tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2520 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2521 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2522 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2523
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002524tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002525tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002526tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2527tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2528tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002529 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2530 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2531 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2532 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2533 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2534 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2535 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2536 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002537
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002538 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2539 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2540 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2541 all available space is consumed.
2542 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2543 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2544 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002545
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002546tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2547 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002548 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002549 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002550 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002551 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2552
2553tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2554 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2555 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2557 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025593.3. Debugging
2560--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002561
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002562quiet
2563 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2564 line argument "-q".
2565
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002566zero-warning
2567 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2568 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2569 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2570 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2571 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2572 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2573
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010025753.4. Userlists
2576--------------
2577It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2578http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2579it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2580
2581userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002582 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002583 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2584
2585group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002586 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002587 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2588 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2589
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002590user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2591 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002592 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2593 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002594 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2595 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2596 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2597 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002598
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002599 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2600 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2601 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2602 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2603 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2604 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2605 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2606 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2607 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002608
2609 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002610 userlist L1
2611 group G1 users tiger,scott
2612 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002613
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002614 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2615 user scott insecure-password elgato
2616 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002618 userlist L2
2619 group G1
2620 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002621
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002622 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2623 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2624 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002625
2626 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002627
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002628
26293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002630----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002631It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2632several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2633instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2634values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2635automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2636In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2637using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2638tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2639reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2640Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2641that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2642each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002643
2644peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002645 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002646 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2647
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002648bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2649 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2650 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2651
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002652disabled
2653 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2654 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2655 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2656
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002657default-bind [param*]
2658 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2659
2660default-server [param*]
2661 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2662
2663 Arguments:
2664 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2665 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2666 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2667 details.
2668
2669
2670 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2671
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002672enable
2673 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2674
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002675log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2676 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2677 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2678 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2679 more details.
2680
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002681peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002682 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2683 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002684 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2685 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2686 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2687 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2688 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002689
2690 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2691 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2692
2693 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002694 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2695 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2696 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002697
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002698 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2699 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002700
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002701 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2702 "server" keyword explanation below).
2703
2704server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002705 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002706 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2707 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2708 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2709 of this "peers" section).
2710 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2711
2712
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002713 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002714 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002715 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002716 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2717 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2718 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002719
2720 backend mybackend
2721 mode tcp
2722 balance roundrobin
2723 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2724 stick on src
2725
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002726 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2727 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002728
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002729 Example:
2730 peers mypeers
2731 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2732 default-server ssl verify none
2733 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2734 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002735
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002736
2737table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2738 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2739
2740 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2741 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002742 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002743 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2744 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2745 "stick-table" keyword).
2746
2747 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2748 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2749 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2750 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2751 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2752 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2753 of the stick-table name as follows:
2754
2755 peers mypeers
2756 peer A ...
2757 peer B ...
2758 table t1 ...
2759
2760 frontend fe1
2761 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2762
2763 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2764 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2765
2766 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2767 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2768 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2769 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2770 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2771 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2772 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2773
2774 peers mypeers
2775 peer A ...
2776 peer B ...
2777 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2778
2779 backend t1
2780 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2781
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002782 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002783 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2784 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2785
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090027863.6. Mailers
2787------------
2788It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2789If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2790in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2791
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002792mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002793 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2794 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2795
2796mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2797 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2798
2799 Example:
2800 mailers mymailers
2801 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2802 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2803
2804 backend mybackend
2805 mode tcp
2806 balance roundrobin
2807
2808 email-alert mailers mymailers
2809 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2810 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2811
2812 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2813 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2814
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002815timeout mail <time>
2816 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2817 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2818 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2819 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2820
2821 Example:
2822 mailers mymailers
2823 timeout mail 20s
2824 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002825
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028263.7. Programs
2827-------------
2828In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2829master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2830managed the same way as the workers.
2831
2832During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2833sequence as a worker:
2834
2835 - the master is re-executed
2836 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2837 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2838 instance of the program
2839
2840During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2841
2842program <name>
2843 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2844 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2845 the management guide).
2846
2847command <command> [arguments*]
2848 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2849 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2850 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2851 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2852
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002853user <user name>
2854 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2855 See also "group".
2856
2857group <group name>
2858 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2859 See also "user".
2860
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002861option start-on-reload
2862no option start-on-reload
2863 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2864 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2865 program section.
2866
2867
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028683.8. HTTP-errors
2869----------------
2870
2871It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2872imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2873several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2874
2875http-errors <name>
2876 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2877 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2878
2879errorfile <code> <file>
2880 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2881
2882 Arguments :
2883 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002884 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2885 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002886
2887 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2888 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2889 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2890 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2891 before any chroot is performed.
2892
2893 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2894
2895 Example:
2896 http-errors website-1
2897 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2898 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2899 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2900
2901 http-errors website-2
2902 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2903 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2904 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2905
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029063.9. Rings
2907----------
2908
2909It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2910servers or traces.
2911
2912ring <ringname>
2913 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2914
2915description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002916 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002917 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2918
2919format <format>
2920 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2921
2922 Arguments:
2923 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2924 one of the following :
2925
2926 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2927 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2928 designed to be used with a local log server.
2929
2930 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2931 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2932 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2933 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2934 is the default.
2935
2936 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2937 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2938
2939 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2940 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2941
2942 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2943 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2944 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2945 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2946 logger consumes.
2947
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002948 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2949 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2950 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2951 with a local log server.
2952
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002953 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2954 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2955 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2956 used with a local log server.
2957
2958maxlen <length>
2959 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2960 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2961 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2962
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002963server <name> <address> [param*]
2964 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2965 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2966 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2967 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2968 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2969 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2970 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2971 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2972 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002973 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2974 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002975
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002976size <size>
2977 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2978 set to BUFSIZE.
2979
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002980timeout connect <timeout>
2981 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2982
2983 Arguments :
2984 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2985 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2986 as explained at the top of this document.
2987
2988timeout server <timeout>
2989 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2990
2991 Arguments :
2992 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2994 as explained at the top of this document.
2995
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002996 Example:
2997 global
2998 log ring@myring local7
2999
3000 ring myring
3001 description "My local buffer"
3002 format rfc3164
3003 maxlen 1200
3004 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003005 timeout connect 5s
3006 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003007 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003008
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030093.10. Log forwarding
3010-------------------
3011
3012It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3013haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3014
3015log-forward <name>
3016 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3017
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003018backlog <conns>
3019 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3020 on connections accept.
3021
3022bind <addr> [param*]
3023 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003024 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3025 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3026 syslog protocol over TCP.
3027 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003028 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3029
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003030dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003031 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3032 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3033 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3034 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003035 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003036
3037log global
3038log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
3039 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3040 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3041 documentation.
3042 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3043 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3044 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3045 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3046 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3047
3048 Example:
3049 global
3050 log stderr format iso local7
3051
3052 ring myring
3053 description "My local buffer"
3054 format rfc5424
3055 maxlen 1200
3056 size 32764
3057 timeout connect 5s
3058 timeout server 10s
3059 # syslog tcp server
3060 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3061
3062 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003063 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3064 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003065 # all messages on stderr
3066 log global
3067 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3068 log ring@myring local0
3069 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3070 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3071 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3072 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3073 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003074
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003075maxconn <conns>
3076 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3077 10 is the default.
3078
3079timeout client <timeout>
3080 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030824. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003083----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003085Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003086 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003087 - frontend <name>
3088 - backend <name>
3089 - listen <name>
3090
3091A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3092its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3093section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003095
3096A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3097connections.
3098
3099A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3100to forward incoming connections.
3101
3102A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3103parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3106'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3107case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3108
3109Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3110logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3111proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3112However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3113name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3114
3115Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3116and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003117bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003118protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3119modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3120arbitrary criteria.
3121
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003122In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3123a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003124the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003125
3126 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3127 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3128 between responses and new requests.
3129
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003130 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3131 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3132 client-facing connection remains open.
3133
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003134 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3135 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003136
3137The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3138frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3139following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003140weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003141
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003142 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003143
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003144 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3145 ----+-----+-----+----
3146 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3147 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003148 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3149 ----+-----+-----+----
3150 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003152
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031544.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3155--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003157The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3158limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3159they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3160limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003161marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003162option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003163and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3164with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3165specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003167
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003168 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3169------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3170acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003171backlog X X X -
3172balance X - X X
3173bind - X X -
3174bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003175capture cookie - X X -
3176capture request header - X X -
3177capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003178clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3179clitcpka-idle X X X -
3180clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003181compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003182cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003183declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003184default-server X - X X
3185default_backend X X X -
3186description - X X X
3187disabled X X X X
3188dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003189email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003190email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003191email-alert mailers X X X X
3192email-alert myhostname X X X X
3193email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003194enabled X X X X
3195errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003196errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003197errorloc X X X X
3198errorloc302 X X X X
3199-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3200errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003201force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003202filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003203fullconn X - X X
3204grace X X X X
3205hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003206http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003207http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003208http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003209http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003210http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003211http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003212http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003213http-check set-var X - X X
3214http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003215http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003216http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003217http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003218http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003219http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003220id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003221ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003222load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003223log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003224log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003225log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003226log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003227max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003228maxconn X X X -
3229mode X X X X
3230monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003231monitor-uri X X X -
3232option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3233option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3234option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3235option allbackups (*) X - X X
3236option checkcache (*) X - X X
3237option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3238option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003239option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003240option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3241option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003242-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3243option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003244option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3245option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003246option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003247option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003248option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003249option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003250option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003251option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3252option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3253option httpchk X - X X
3254option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003255option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003256option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003257option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003258option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003259option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003260option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3261option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3262option logasap (*) X X X -
3263option mysql-check X - X X
3264option nolinger (*) X X X X
3265option originalto X X X X
3266option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003267option pgsql-check X - X X
3268option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003269option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003270option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003271option smtpchk X - X X
3272option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3273option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3274option splice-request (*) X X X X
3275option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003276option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003277option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3278option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3279-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003280option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003281option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3282option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3283option tcpka X X X X
3284option tcplog X X X X
3285option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003286external-check command X - X X
3287external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003288persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3289rate-limit sessions X X X -
3290redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003291-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003292retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003293retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003294server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003295server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003296server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003297source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003298srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3299srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3300srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003301stats admin - X X X
3302stats auth X X X X
3303stats enable X X X X
3304stats hide-version X X X X
3305stats http-request - X X X
3306stats realm X X X X
3307stats refresh X X X X
3308stats scope X X X X
3309stats show-desc X X X X
3310stats show-legends X X X X
3311stats show-node X X X X
3312stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003313-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3314stick match - - X X
3315stick on - - X X
3316stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003317stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003318stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003319tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003320tcp-check connect X - X X
3321tcp-check expect X - X X
3322tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003323tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003324tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003325tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003326tcp-check set-var X - X X
3327tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003328tcp-request connection - X X -
3329tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003330tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003331tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003332tcp-response content - - X X
3333tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003334timeout check X - X X
3335timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003336timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003337timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003338timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3339timeout http-request X X X X
3340timeout queue X - X X
3341timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003342timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003343timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003344timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003345transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003346unique-id-format X X X -
3347unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003348use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003349use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003350use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003351------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3352 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033554.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3356---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003357
3358This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3359
3360
3361acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3362 Declare or complete an access list.
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 no | yes | yes | yes
3365 Example:
3366 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3367 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3368 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003370 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371
3372
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003373backlog <conns>
3374 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3376 yes | yes | yes | no
3377 Arguments :
3378 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3379 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003380 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003381
3382 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3383 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3384 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3385 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3386 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3387 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3388 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3389 backlog parameter.
3390
3391 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3392 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3393 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3394
3395 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3396
3397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003399balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003400 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3402 yes | no | yes | yes
3403 Arguments :
3404 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3405 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3406 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3407 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3408
3409 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3410 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3411 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3412 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003413 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003414 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003415 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3416 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3417 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3418 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3419 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3420 it, so that you don't worry.
3421
3422 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3423 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3424 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3425 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3426 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3427 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3428 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3429 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003430
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003431 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3432 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3433 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3434 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3435 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3436 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3437 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003438 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3439 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3440 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003441
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003442 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003443 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003444 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3445 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003446 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003447 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3448 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3449 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3450 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3451 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003452 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3453 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3454 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3455 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3456 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3457 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3460 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3461 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3462 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3463 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3464 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3465 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3466 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003467 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003469 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3470 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3471 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003473 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3474 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3475 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3476 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3477 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3478 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3479 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3480 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3481 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3482 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3483 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3484 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003486 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003487 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3488 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3489 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3490 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3491 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3492 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3493 URIs start with a leading "/".
3494
3495 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3496 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3497 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3498 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3499
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003500 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3501 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3502 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3503 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003506 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3507
3508 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003509 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3510 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003511 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3512 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3513 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3514 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003515 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003516 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3517 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003518
3519 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3520 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3521 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3522 server will receive the request.
3523
3524 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3525 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3526 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3527 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3528 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003529 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3530 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3531 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003532
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003533 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3534 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3535 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3536 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3537 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003538
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003539 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003540 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3541 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3542 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3543
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003544 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3545 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3546 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3547
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003548 random
3549 random(<draws>)
3550 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003551 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3552 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3553 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3554 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003555 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3556 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3557 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3558 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3559 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3560 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3561 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3562 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3563 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3564 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3565 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3566 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3567 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3568 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3569 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3570 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3571 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3572 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3573 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3574 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003575
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003576 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003577 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003578 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3579 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3580 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3581 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3582 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3583 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003584 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003585 used instead.
3586
3587 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3588 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3589 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3590 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3591
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003592 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3593 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3594 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3595
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003596 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003599 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3600 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003601
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003602 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3603 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3604 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003605
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003606 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003607 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003608 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3609 NTLM relies on.
3610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611 Examples :
3612 balance roundrobin
3613 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003614 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003615 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3616 balance hdr(host)
3617 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003618
3619 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3620 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003622 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003623 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3624 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3625 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003626 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003627
3628 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3629 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3630 defaults to 16 kB.
3631
3632 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3633 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3634
3635 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3636 Round Robin.
3637
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003638 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003639 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3640 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3641 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3642
3643 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3644
3645 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003646 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003647 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3648 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3649 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003650
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003651 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652
3653
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003654bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3655bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003656 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3658 no | yes | yes | no
3659 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003660 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3661 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3662 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3663 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003664 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003665 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3666 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3667 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3668 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3669 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3670 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003671 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003672 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3673 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003674 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003675 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3676 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003677 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003678 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3679 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003680 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003681 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3682 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3683 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3684 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3685 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3686 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3687 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003688 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3689 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3690 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003691 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3692 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3693 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3694 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003695 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3696 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3697 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003698
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003699 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3700 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003701 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3702 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3703 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003704 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3705 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3706 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3707 the range.
3708
3709 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3710 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3711 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3712 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3713 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3714 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3715 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003716 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003717 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003718
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003719 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003720 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003721 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3722 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3723 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3724 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3725 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3726 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3727
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003728 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3729 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3730 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3731 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003733 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3734 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3735 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3736 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3737 in a frontend.
3738
3739 Example :
3740 listen http_proxy
3741 bind :80,:443
3742 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003743 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003745 listen http_https_proxy
3746 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003747 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003748
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003749 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3750 bind ipv6@:80
3751 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3752 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3753
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003754 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003755 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003756
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003757 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3758 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3759 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3760 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3761 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3762
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003763 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003764 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003765
3766
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003767bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003768 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | yes
3771 Arguments :
3772 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3773 may be used to override a default value.
3774
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003775 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003776 option may be combined with other numbers.
3777
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003778 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003779 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3780 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3781 missing from all processes.
3782
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003783 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003784 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003785 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3786 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3787 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3788 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3789 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003790 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003791
3792 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3793 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3794 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3795 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3796 and 'even' instances.
3797
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003798 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3799 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3800 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3801 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003802
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003803 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3804 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3805
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003806 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3807 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3808 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3809
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003810 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3811 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3812
3813 Example :
3814 listen app_ip1
3815 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003816 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003817
3818 listen app_ip2
3819 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003820 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003821
3822 listen management
3823 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003824 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003825
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003826 listen management
3827 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3828 bind-process 1-4
3829
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003830 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003831
3832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003833capture cookie <name> len <length>
3834 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3836 no | yes | yes | no
3837 Arguments :
3838 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3839 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3840 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3841 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003842 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003843
3844 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3845 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3846 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3847 right if it exceeds <length>.
3848
3849 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3850 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3851 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3852 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3853
3854 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3855 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3856 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3857
3858 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3859 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3860 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003861 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3862 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3863 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003864
3865 Example:
3866 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3867
3868 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003869 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870
3871
3872capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003873 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3875 no | yes | yes | no
3876 Arguments :
3877 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003878 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003879 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3880 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3881 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3882
3883 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3884 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3885 it exceeds <length>.
3886
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003887 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003888 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3889 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003890 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3891 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3892 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3893 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003894 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003895 environments to find where the request came from.
3896
3897 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3898 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3899 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3900 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003901
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003902 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3903 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3904 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3905 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3906 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003907
3908 Example:
3909 capture request header Host len 15
3910 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003911 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003913 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003914 about logging.
3915
3916
3917capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003918 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 no | yes | yes | no
3921 Arguments :
3922 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003923 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003924 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3925 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3926 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3927
3928 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3929 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3930 it exceeds <length>.
3931
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003932 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003933 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3934 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3935 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003936 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3937 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3938 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3939 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003940
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003941 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3942 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3943 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3944 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3945 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946
3947 Example:
3948 capture response header Content-length len 9
3949 capture response header Location len 15
3950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003951 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003952 about logging.
3953
3954
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003955clitcpka-cnt <count>
3956 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3957 the connection on the client side.
3958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | yes | yes | no
3960 Arguments :
3961 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3962
3963 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3964 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003965 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3966 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003967
3968 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3969
3970
3971clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3972 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3973 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3974 client side.
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3976 yes | yes | yes | no
3977 Arguments :
3978 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3979 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3980 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3981 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3982
3983 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3984 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003985 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3986 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003987
3988 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3989
3990
3991clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3992 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3994 yes | yes | yes | no
3995 Arguments :
3996 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3997 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3998 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3999 document.
4000
4001 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4002 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004003 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4004 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004005
4006 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4007
4008
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004009compression algo <algorithm> ...
4010compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004011compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004012 Enable HTTP compression.
4013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4014 yes | yes | yes | yes
4015 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004016 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4017 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4018 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4019
4020 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004021 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4022 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4023 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004024
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004025 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004026 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004027
4028 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4029 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4030 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4031 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4032 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004033 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004034
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004035 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4036 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4037 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4038 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4039 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4040 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4041 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004042 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004043
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004044 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004045 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004046 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4047 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4048 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4049 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4050 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004051
4052 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4053 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4054 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4055 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4056 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004057 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4058 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4059 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4060 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4061 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004062 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4063 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004064
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004065 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004066 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4067 "Accept-Encoding" header
4068 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004069 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004070 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4071 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4072 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4073 "multipart"
4074 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4075 header
4076 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4077 and later
4078 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4079 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004080 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004081
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004082 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004083
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004084 Examples :
4085 compression algo gzip
4086 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004087
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004088
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004089cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004090 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4091 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004092 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004093 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | no | yes | yes
4096 Arguments :
4097 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4098 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4099 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4100 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4101 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4102 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004103 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4105 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4106
4107 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4108 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4109 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4110 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4111 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4112 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004113 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4114 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004115 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004116 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4117 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004118
4119 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004120 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004121
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004122 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004123 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004124 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004125 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004126 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4127 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4128 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4129 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4130 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4131 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4132 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004133
4134 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4135 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4136 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4137 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4138 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4139 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4140 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4141 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4142 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004143 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004144 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4145 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4146 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004148 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4149 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4150 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004151 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4152 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4153 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4154 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004155 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4156 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4157 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004158
4159 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4160 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4161 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4162 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4163 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4164 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4165 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4166 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4167 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4168
4169 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4170 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4171 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4172 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4173 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4174 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4175 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4176 persistence cookie in the cache.
4177 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4178
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004179 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4180 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4181 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4182 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4183 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004184 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004185 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4186 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4187 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4188 they logout.
4189
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004190 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4191 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4192 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4193 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4194
4195 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4196 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4197 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4198 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4199 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4200 this attribute.
4201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004202 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004203 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004204 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4205 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4206 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4207 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4208 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4209 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004210
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004211 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4212 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4213 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4214 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4215 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4216 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4217 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4218 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004219 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004220 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4221 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4222 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4223 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4224 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4225 the site.
4226
4227 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4228 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4229 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4230 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4231 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4232 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4233 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4234 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4235 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4236 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4237 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4238 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4239 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004240 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004241 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4242 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4243
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004244 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4245 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4246 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4247 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4248 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4249 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4250
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004251 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4252 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4253 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4254 repeated.
4255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004256 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4257 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4258 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4259 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261 Examples :
4262 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4263 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4264 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004265 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004266
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004267 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004268
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004269
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004270declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4271 Declares a capture slot.
4272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4273 no | yes | yes | no
4274 Arguments:
4275 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4276
4277 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4278 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4279 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4280 for use in the response.
4281
4282 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004283 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004284 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4285
4286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004287default-server [param*]
4288 Change default options for a server in a backend
4289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 yes | no | yes | yes
4291 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4295 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004296
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004297 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004298 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4299
4300 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004301
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004303default_backend <backend>
4304 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4306 yes | yes | yes | no
4307 Arguments :
4308 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4309
4310 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4311 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4312 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4313 will catch all undetermined requests.
4314
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315 Example :
4316
4317 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4318 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4319 default_backend dynamic
4320
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004321 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004324description <string>
4325 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 no | yes | yes | yes
4328 Arguments : string
4329
4330 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4331 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4332 it describes.
4333 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4334
4335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336disabled
4337 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 yes | yes | yes | yes
4340 Arguments : none
4341
4342 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4343 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4344 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4345 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4346 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4347 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4348 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4349
4350 See also : "enabled"
4351
4352
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004353dispatch <address>:<port>
4354 Set a default server address
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004357 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004358
4359 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4360 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4361 during start-up.
4362
4363 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4364 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4365 possible with normal servers.
4366
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004367 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004368 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4369 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4370 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4371 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4372
4373 See also : "server"
4374
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004375
4376dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4377 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | no | yes | yes
4380 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4381
4382 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004383 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004384 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4385 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004386 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004387 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004389enabled
4390 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 yes | yes | yes | yes
4393 Arguments : none
4394
4395 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4396 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4397
4398 See also : "disabled"
4399
4400
4401errorfile <code> <file>
4402 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4404 yes | yes | yes | yes
4405 Arguments :
4406 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004407 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004408 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004409
4410 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004411 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004412 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004413 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4414 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004415
4416 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4417 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4418 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4419
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004420 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4421
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004422 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4423 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4424 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4425 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4426 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4427 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4428 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4429 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4430 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004432 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4433 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4434 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004435 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004436 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4437
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004438 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004439
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004440 Example :
4441 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004442 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004443 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4444 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004446
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004447errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4448 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4449 section.
4450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4451 yes | yes | yes | yes
4452 Arguments :
4453 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4454
4455 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004456 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004457 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004458
4459 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4460 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4461 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4462 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4463 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004464 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004465 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4466
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004467 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4468 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004469
4470 Example :
4471 errorfiles generic
4472 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4473
4474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004475errorloc <code> <url>
4476errorloc302 <code> <url>
4477 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 yes | yes | yes | yes
4480 Arguments :
4481 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004482 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004483 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004484
4485 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4486 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4487 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4488 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004489 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004490
4491 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4492 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4493 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4494
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004495 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004497 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4498 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4499 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4500 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004501 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004502 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4503 request.
4504
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004505 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004506
4507
4508errorloc303 <code> <url>
4509 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4511 yes | yes | yes | yes
4512 Arguments :
4513 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004514 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004515 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004516
4517 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4518 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4519 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4520 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004521 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004522
4523 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4524 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4525 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4526
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004527 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4528
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004529 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4530 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4531 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4532 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004533 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004534
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004535 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004536
4537
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004538email-alert from <emailaddr>
4539 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004540 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004541 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4542 yes | yes | yes | yes
4543
4544 Arguments :
4545
4546 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4547
4548 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4549 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4550
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004551 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004552 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4553 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004554
4555
4556email-alert level <level>
4557 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4558 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4559 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4560 yes | yes | yes | yes
4561
4562 Arguments :
4563
4564 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4565 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4566 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4567
4568 By default level is alert
4569
4570 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4571 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4572 for the proxy.
4573
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004574 Alerts are sent when :
4575
4576 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4577 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4578 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4579 is notice or lower
4580 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4581 and a health check status update occurs
4582
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004583 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4584 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004585 section 3.6 about mailers.
4586
4587
4588email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4589 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4590 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4591 yes | yes | yes | yes
4592
4593 Arguments :
4594
4595 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4596
4597 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4598 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4599
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004600 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4601 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004602
4603
4604email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4605 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4606 mailers.
4607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | yes
4609
4610 Arguments :
4611
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004612 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004613
4614 By default the systems hostname is used.
4615
4616 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4617 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4618 for the proxy.
4619
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004620 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4621 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004622
4623
4624email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004625 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004626 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4628 yes | yes | yes | yes
4629
4630 Arguments :
4631
4632 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4633
4634 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4635 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4636
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004637 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004638 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4639
4640
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004641force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4642 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4643 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004644 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004645
4646 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4647 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4648 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4649 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4650 marked down for maintenance operations.
4651
4652 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4653 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4654 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4655 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4656 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4657 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4658 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4659 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4660 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4661
4662 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4663 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4664 is used.
4665
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004666 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004667 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004668
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004669
4670filter <name> [param*]
4671 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 no | yes | yes | yes
4674 Arguments :
4675 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4676 referenced in section 9.
4677
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004678 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004679 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004680 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4681 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004682
4683 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4684 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4685
4686 Example:
4687 listen
4688 bind *:80
4689
4690 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4691 filter compression
4692 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4693
4694 compression algo gzip
4695 compression offload
4696
4697 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4698
4699 See also : section 9.
4700
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004702fullconn <conns>
4703 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4705 yes | no | yes | yes
4706 Arguments :
4707 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4708 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4709
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004710 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004711 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004712 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004713 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4714 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4715 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4716 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4717 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004718 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004720 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4721 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004722 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4723 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4724 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004726 Example :
4727 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4728 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4729 # connections.
4730 backend dynamic
4731 fullconn 10000
4732 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4733 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4734
4735 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4736
4737
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004738grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004741 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004742 Arguments :
4743 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4744 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4745 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4746
4747 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4748 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004749 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004750 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4751
4752 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4753 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4754 simplify it.
4755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004756
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004757hash-balance-factor <factor>
4758 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4760 yes | no | no | yes
4761 Arguments :
4762 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4763 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004764 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004765
4766 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4767 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4768 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4769 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4770 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4771 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4772 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4773
4774 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4775 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4776 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4777 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4778 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4779
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004780 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4781 consistent hashing mechanism.
4782
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004783 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4784
4785
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004786hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004787 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4789 yes | no | yes | yes
4790 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004791 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4792 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004793
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004794 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4795 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4796 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4797 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4798 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4799 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4800 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4801 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4802 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4803 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004804
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004805 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4806 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4807 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4808 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4809 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4810 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4811 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4812 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4813 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4814 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4815 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4816 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4817 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004818 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4819 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004820
4821 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4822
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004823 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004824 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4825 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4826 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004827 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4828 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4829 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004830
4831 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4832 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004833 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4834 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4835 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4836 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4837
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004838 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4839 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4840 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4841 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4842 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4843 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4844 parameter.
4845
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004846 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4847 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4848 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4849 used on strings.
4850
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004851 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4852
4853 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4854 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4855 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4856 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4857 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4858 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4859 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4860 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4861 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4862 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4863 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4864 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004865
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004866 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4867 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4868 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004869
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004870 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004871
4872
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004873http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4874 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4875 ones).
4876
4877 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 no | yes | yes | yes
4879
4880 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4881 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4882 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4883 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4884 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4885 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4886
4887 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4888 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4889 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4890
4891 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4892 below.
4893
4894 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4895 instance.
4896
4897 Example:
4898 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4899 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4900 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4901
4902http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4903
4904 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4905 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4906 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4907 example, or to pass some internal information.
4908 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4909 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4910 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4911
4912http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4913
4914 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4915 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4916
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004917http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004918
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004919 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4920 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4921 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4922 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4923 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004924
4925http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4926 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4927
4928 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4929
4930 Example:
4931 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4932
4933 # applied to:
4934 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4935
4936 # outputs:
4937 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4938
4939 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4940
4941http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4942 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4943
4944 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4945
4946 Example:
4947 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4948
4949 # applied to:
4950 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4951
4952 # outputs:
4953 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4954
4955http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4956
4957 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4958 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4959 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4960
4961http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4963
4964 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4965 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4966 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4967 fallback.
4968
4969 Example:
4970 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4971 http-response set-status 431
4972 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4973 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4974
4975http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4976
4977 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4978 inline.
4979
4980 Arguments:
4981 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4982 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4983 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4984 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4985 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4986 (request and response)
4987 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4988 processing
4989 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4990 processing
4991 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4992 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4993 and '_'.
4994
4995 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4996 followed by some converters.
4997
4998 Example:
4999 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5000
5001http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5002
5003 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5004 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5005 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5006 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5007 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005008 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005009 processing.
5010
5011 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5012 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005013 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005014 rules evaluation.
5015
5016http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5017
5018 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5019 details about <var-name>.
5020
5021 Example:
5022 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5023
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005024
5025http-check comment <string>
5026 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5027 it fails.
5028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5029 yes | no | yes | yes
5030
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005031 Arguments :
5032 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5033 rule fails.
5034
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005035 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5036 user-friendly error reporting.
5037
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005038 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005039 "http-check expect".
5040
5041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005042http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5043 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005044 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005045 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5047 yes | no | yes | yes
5048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005049 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005050 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5051
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005052 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005053 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005054
5055 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5056 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5057 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5058 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5059
5060 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5061
5062 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5063
5064 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5065
5066 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5067
5068 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5069
5070 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5071 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5072 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5073 is used.
5074
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005075 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5076 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5077 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5078 haproxy -vv.
5079
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005080 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5081
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005082 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5083 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5084 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5085 different ports or with different servers.
5086
5087 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5088 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5089 the port with a "http-check connect".
5090
5091 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5092 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5093 do.
5094
5095 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5096 unset-var or comment rules.
5097
5098 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005099 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5100 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5101 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5102 option httpchk
5103
5104 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005105 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005106 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005107 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005108 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005109 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005110
5111 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5112
5113 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005114
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005116http-check disable-on-404
5117 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005119 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005120 Arguments : none
5121
5122 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5123 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5124 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5125 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5126 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5127 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5128 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5129 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005130 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5131 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
5132 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
5133
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005134 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005135
5136
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005137http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005138 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5139 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5140 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005141 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005143 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005144
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005145 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005146 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5147
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005148 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5149 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5150 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5151 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5152 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5153 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5154 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5155 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5156 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5157 result is always conclusive.
5158
5159 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5160 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5161 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005162 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5163 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005164 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5165 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005166 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5167 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5168 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005169
5170 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5171 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005172 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5173 supported :
5174 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5175 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005176 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5177 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5178 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5179 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5180 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005181
5182 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5183 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005184 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5185 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5186 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5187 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005188 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5189
5190 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5191 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5192 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5193 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5194
5195 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5196 informational message reported in logs if an error
5197 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5198 log-format string.
5199
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005200 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005201 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5202 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005203 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5204 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5205 details on the supported keywords.
5206
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005207 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5208 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5209 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5210 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005211
5212 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5213 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5214 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5215 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5216 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5217
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005218 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5219 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5220 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5221 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5222 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5223 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5224 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005225
5226 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005227 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005228 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5229 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5230 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5231 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5232
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005233 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5234 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005235 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5236 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5237 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5238 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5239 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5240 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5241 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5242 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005243 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5244 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5245 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5246 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5247 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5248 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5249 insensitive on the header names.
5250
5251 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5252 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5253 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5254 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5255 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5256 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005257
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005258 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005259 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005260 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5261 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5262 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5263 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5264 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005265 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005266 trace).
5267
5268 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005269 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005270 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5271 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5272 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5273 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5274 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005275 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005276
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005277 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5278 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5279 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5280 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5281 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5282 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5283
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005284 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005285 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005286 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5287 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5288 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5289 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5290 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5291 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5292
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005293 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5294 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5295 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5296 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5297 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005298
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005299 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5300 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5301
5302 Examples :
5303 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005304 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005305
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005306 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5307 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5308
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005309 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005310 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005311
5312 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005313 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005314
5315 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005316 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005317
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005318 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005319 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005320
5321
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005322http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005323 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5324 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005325 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5326 health checks.
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | no | yes | yes
5329 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005330 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5331
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005332 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5333 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5334 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5335 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5336 to invent non-standard ones.
5337
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005338 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5339 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5340 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5341 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5342
5343 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5344 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5345 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5346 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005347
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005348 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005349 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005350 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005351 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5352 to add it.
5353
5354 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5355 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5356 to the log-format rules.
5357
5358 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5359 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5360 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005361
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005362 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5363 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5364 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5365 request.
5366
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005367 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5368 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5369 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005370 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5371 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5372 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5373 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005374 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005375 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005376 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5377
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005378 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5379 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005380 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5381 so, it will be ignored.
5382
5383 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5384 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5385 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5386 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5387 configured request authority.
5388
5389 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5390 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005391
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005392 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005393
5394
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005395http-check send-state
5396 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5398 yes | no | yes | yes
5399 Arguments : none
5400
5401 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5402 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5403 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5404 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5405 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5406
5407 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5408 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5409 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5410 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5411 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005412 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5413 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5414 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5415
5416 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5417 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5418 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5419
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005420 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5421 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5422 checked in multiple backends.
5423
5424 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5425 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5426
5427 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5428 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5429 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5430 one fails.
5431
5432 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5433 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5434 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5435
5436 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5437 server's queue.
5438
5439 Example of a header received by the application server :
5440 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5441 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5442
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005443 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5444 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005445
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005446
5447http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005448 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5450 yes | no | yes | yes
5451
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005452 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005453 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5454 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5455 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5456 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5457 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5458 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5459 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5460 and '-'.
5461
5462 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5463
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005464 Examples :
5465 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005466
5467
5468http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005469 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5471 yes | no | yes | yes
5472
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005473 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005474 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5475 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5476 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5477 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5478 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5479 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5480 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5481 and '-'.
5482
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005483 Examples :
5484 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005486
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005487http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5488 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5489 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5490 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5491 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | yes | yes | yes
5494 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005495 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005496 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005497 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5498 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005499
5500 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5501 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5502 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5503 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5504
5505 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5506 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5507 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5508 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5509
5510 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5511 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5512 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5513 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5514 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5515 chroot is performed.
5516
5517 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5518 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5519 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5520 considered.
5521
5522 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5523 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5524 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5525 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5526 considered as a raw string.
5527
5528 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5529 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5530 "content-type".
5531
5532 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5533 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5534 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5535 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5536 evaluated as a log-format string.
5537
5538 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5539 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5540 argument to "content-type".
5541
5542 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5543 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5544 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5545 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5546
5547 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5548 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5549 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5550 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5551 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5552 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5553 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5554 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5555
5556 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5557 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5558 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5559
5560 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5561 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5562
5563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005564http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005565 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5566
5567 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5568 no | yes | yes | yes
5569
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005570 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5571 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5572 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5573 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5574 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005576 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5577 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005579 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005581 Example:
5582 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5583 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5584 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005586 http-request allow if nagios
5587 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5588 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5589 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005591 Example:
5592 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5593 acl add path /addacl
5594 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005596 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005598 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5599 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005601 Example:
5602 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5603 acl setmap path /setmap
5604 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005606 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005608 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5609 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005611 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5612 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005614http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005616 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5617 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5618 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5619 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5620 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5621 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5622 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5623 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005625http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005627 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5628 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5629 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5630 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5631 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5632 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5633 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5634 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005636http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005638 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5639 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005640
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005642http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005644 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5645 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5646 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5647 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5648 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005649
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005650 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5651 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5652 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5653 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5654 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5655 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5656 instead.
5657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005658 Example:
5659 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5660 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005661
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005662http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005663
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005664 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005666http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5667 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005669 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5670 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5671 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5672 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5673 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5674 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5675 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5676 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5677 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005679 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5680 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5681 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005682 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5683
5684 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5685 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5686 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5687 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005689http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005691 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5692 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5693 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5694 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5695 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5696 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005697
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005698http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005699
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005700 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5701 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5702 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5703 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5704 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005706http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005708 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5709 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5710 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5711 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5712 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5713 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005714
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005715http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5716http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5717 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5718 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5719 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5720 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005721
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005722 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5723 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5724 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005725 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005726 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5727 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5728 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005729 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005730 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005731
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005732http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5733 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5734 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5735 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5736
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005737http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5738
5739 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5740 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5741 pointed by <resolvers>.
5742 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5743 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5744 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5745 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5746 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5747 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5748 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5749 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5750 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5751 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5752 to 0.0.0.0.
5753
5754 Example:
5755 resolvers mydns
5756 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5757 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5758 timeout retry 1s
5759 hold valid 10s
5760 hold nx 3s
5761 hold other 3s
5762 hold obsolete 0s
5763 accepted_payload_size 8192
5764
5765 frontend fe
5766 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5767 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5768 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5769
5770 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5771 # which mean DNS resolution error
5772 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5773
5774 default_backend be
5775
5776 backend b_503
5777 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5778 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5779 # 503 error page to end users
5780
5781 backend be
5782 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5783 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5784 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5785 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5786 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5787
5788 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5789 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5790
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005791http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5792
5793 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5794 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5795 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5796 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005797 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5798 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005799
5800 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005802http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005804 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5805 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5806 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5807 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5808 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005810http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005812 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5813 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5814 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5815 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005817http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5818 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005819
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005820 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005821 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5822 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5823 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5824 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5825 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005826
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005827 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5828 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5829 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5830 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5831 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005832
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005833 Example:
5834 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5835
5836 # applied to:
5837 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5838
5839 # outputs:
5840 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5841
5842 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005843
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005844 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5845
5846 # applied to:
5847 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005848
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005849 # outputs:
5850 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005851
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005852http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5853 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5854
5855 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5856 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005857 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5858 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5859 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005860
5861 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5862 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5863 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5864
5865 Example:
5866 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5867 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5868
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005869 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5870 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5871 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5872 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5873
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005874http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5875 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5876
5877 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5878 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5879 query-string are replaced.
5880
5881 Example:
5882 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5883 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5884
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005885http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5886 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5887
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005888 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5889 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5890 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5891 against.
5892
5893 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5894 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5895 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005896
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005897 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5898 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5899 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5900 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5901 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5902 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5903 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5904 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5905 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005906 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5907 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005908
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005909 Example:
5910 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5911 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005912
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005913 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5914 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005916http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5917 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005918
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005919 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5920 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5921 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5922 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005923
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005924 Example:
5925 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005926
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005927 # applied to:
5928 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005929
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005930 # outputs:
5931 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005932
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005933http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5934 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5935 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005936 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005937 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5938
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005939 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005940 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5941 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005942 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005943 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005944 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005945 are followed to create the response :
5946
5947 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5948 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5949 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5950 ignored.
5951
5952 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5953 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005954 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005955 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5956 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005957
5958 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5959 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5960 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005961 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005962 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005963
5964 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5965 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5966 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005967 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005968 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5969 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005970
5971 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5972 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5973 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5974 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5975 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5976 as a raw content.
5977
5978 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5979 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5980 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5981 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5982 considered as a raw string.
5983
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005984 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005985 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5986 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5987 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5988
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005989 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5990 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005991 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005992
5993 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5994
5995 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005996 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005997 if { path /ping }
5998
5999 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6000 if { path /favicon.ico }
6001
6002 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6003 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6004 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006006http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6007http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6010 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6011 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006012
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006013http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6014 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006015
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006016 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6017 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6018 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6019 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006023 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6024 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6025 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6026 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6027 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029 Arguments:
6030 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6031 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006033 Example:
6034 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6035 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006037 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6038 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006040http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006042 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6043 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6044 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006046 Arguments:
6047 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6048 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 Example:
6051 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6052 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6055 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6056 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006060 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6061 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6062 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6063 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6064 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006066 Example:
6067 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6068 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6069 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6070 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6071 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6072 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6073 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6074 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6075 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006077http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006079 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6080 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6081 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6082 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6083 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006085http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6086 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006088 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6089 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6090 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6091 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6092 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6093 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6094 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6095 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6096 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006098http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006100 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6101 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6102 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6103 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6104 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6105 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6106 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006108http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6111 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6112 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006116 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6117 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6118 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6119 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6120 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6121 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6122 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6123 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006125http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006127 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6128 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6129 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6130 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6131 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6132 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006134 Example :
6135 # prepend the host name before the path
6136 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006137
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006138http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6139
6140 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6141 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6142 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006144http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006146 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6147 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6148 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6149 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6150 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006152http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006154 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6155 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6156 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6157 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6158 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6159 values have higher priority.
6160 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6161 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6162 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6163 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6164 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006166http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006168 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6169 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6170 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6171 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6172 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6173 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6174 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006176 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006177
6178 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006179 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6180 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006182http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6183 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6184 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6185 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006186 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6187 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006188
6189 Arguments :
6190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6191 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006192
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006193 See also "option forwardfor".
6194
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006195 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006196 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6197 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6198
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006199 # After the masking this will track connections
6200 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6201 http-request track-sc0 src
6202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006203 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6204 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6205
6206http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6207
6208 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6209 expression.
6210
6211 Arguments:
6212 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6213 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006214
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006215 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006216 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6217 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6218
6219 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6220 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6221 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6222
6223http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6224
6225 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6226 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6227 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6228 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6229 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6230 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6231 information from the request.
6232
6233 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6234
6235http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6236
6237 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6238 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6239 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6240 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6241 path and the query string.
6242 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6243
6244http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6245
6246 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6247 inline.
6248
6249 Arguments:
6250 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6251 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6252 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6253 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6254 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6255 (request and response)
6256 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6257 processing
6258 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6259 processing
6260 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6261 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6262 and '_'.
6263
6264 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6265 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006266
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006267 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006268 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006270http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6271 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006273 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6274 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6275 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6276 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6277 agent name must be used.
6278
6279 Arguments:
6280 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6281
6282 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6283 configuration.
6284
6285http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6286
6287 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6288 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6289 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6290 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6291 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6292 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6293 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6294 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6295 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6296 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6297 action.
6298 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6299 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6300 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6301 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6302 you fully understand how it works.
6303
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006304http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6305
6306 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6307 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6308 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6309 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6310 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006311 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006312 processing.
6313
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006314 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006315 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6316 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6317 rules evaluation.
6318
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006319http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6320http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6321 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6322 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6323 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6324 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006325
6326 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6327 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6328 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006329 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6330 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6331 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6332 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6333 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6334 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6335 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6336 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6337 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6338 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006339 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006340 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6341 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6342 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6343 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6344 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006345
6346http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6347http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6348http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6349
6350 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6351 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6352 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6353 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006354 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006355 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6356 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6357 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6358 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6359 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6360 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6361 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6362
6363 Arguments :
6364 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6365 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6366 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6367 select which table entry to update the counters.
6368
6369 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6370 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6371 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6372 that table until the session ends.
6373
6374 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6375 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6376 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6377 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6378 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6379 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6380 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6381 useful information.
6382
6383 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6384 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6385 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6386 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6387 checks that make use of it.
6388
6389http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6390
6391 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006392
6393 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006394 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006395
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006396http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6397
6398 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6399 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6400 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6401 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6402 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6403 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6404
6405 Arguments :
6406 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6407
6408 Example:
6409 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006411http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006413 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6414 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6415 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006416
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006418http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006419 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6420
6421 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6422 no | yes | yes | yes
6423
6424 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6425 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6426 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6427 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6428 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6429 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006431 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6432 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006433
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006434 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006436 Example:
6437 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006439 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006441 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6442 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006444 Example:
6445 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006446
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006447 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006449 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6450 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006452 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6453 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006454
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006455http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006456
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006457 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6458 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6459 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6460 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6461 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6462 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6463 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6464 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006465
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006466http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006467
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006468 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6469 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6470 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6471 example, or to pass some internal information.
6472 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6473 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6474 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006475
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006476http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006477
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006478 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6479 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006480
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006481http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006482
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006483 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006484
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006485http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006487 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6488 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6489 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6490 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6491 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6492 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6493 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006494
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006495 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6496 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6497 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6498 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6499 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006500
6501 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6502 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6503 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6504 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006505
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006506http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006507
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006508 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6509 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6510 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6511 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6512 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6513 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006514
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006515http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006516
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006517 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6518 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6519 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6520 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6521 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006522
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006523http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006524
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006525 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6526 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6527 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6528 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6529 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6530 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006531
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006532http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6533http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6534 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6535 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6536 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6537 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006538
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006539 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6540 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6541 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006542 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006543 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6544 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6545 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006546 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006547 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006548
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006549http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006550
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006551 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6552 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6553 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6554 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6555 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6556 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006557
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006558http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6559 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006560
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006561 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6562 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006563
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006564 Example:
6565 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006566
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006567 # applied to:
6568 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006569
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006570 # outputs:
6571 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006572
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006573 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006575http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6576 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006577
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006578 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006579 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006580
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006581 Example:
6582 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006583
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006584 # applied to:
6585 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006586
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006587 # outputs:
6588 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006589
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006590http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6591 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6592 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006593 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006594 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6595
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006596 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006597 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6598 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006599 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006600 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006601 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006602 are followed to create the response :
6603
6604 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6605 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6606 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6607 ignored.
6608
6609 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6610 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006611 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006612 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6613 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006614
6615 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6616 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6617 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006618 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006619 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006620
6621 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6622 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6623 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006624 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006625 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6626 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006627
6628 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6629 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6630 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6631 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6632 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6633 as a raw content.
6634
6635 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6636 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6637 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6638 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6639 considered as a raw string.
6640
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006641 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6642 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6643 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6644 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6645
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006646 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6647 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006648 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006649
6650 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6651
6652 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006653 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006654 if { status eq 404 }
6655
6656 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6657 string "This is the end !" \
6658 if { status eq 500 }
6659
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006660http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6661http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006662
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006663 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6664 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6665 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006666
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006667http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6668 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006669
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006670 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6671 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6672 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6673 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006675http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006676
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006677 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6678 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6679 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6680 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6681 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006683 Arguments:
6684 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006685
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006686 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6687 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006688
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006689http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006690
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006691 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6692 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6693 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006695http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6696
6697 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6698 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6699 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6700 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6701 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6702
6703http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6704
6705 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6706 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6707 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6708 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6709 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6710 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6711 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6712 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6713 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6714
6715http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6716
6717 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6718 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6719 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6720 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6721 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6722 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6723 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6724
6725http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6726
6727 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6728 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6729 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6730 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6731 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6732 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6733 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6734 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6735
6736http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6737 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6738
6739 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6740 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6741 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6742 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006743
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006744 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006745 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6746 http-response set-status 431
6747 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6748 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006750http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006752 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6753 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6754 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6755 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6756 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6757 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6758 based on some information from the request.
6759
6760 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6761
6762http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6763
6764 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6765 inline.
6766
6767 Arguments:
6768 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6769 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6770 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6771 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6772 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6773 (request and response)
6774 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6775 processing
6776 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6777 processing
6778 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6779 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6780 and '_'.
6781
6782 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6783 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006784
6785 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006786 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006788http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006790 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6791 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6792 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6793 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6794 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6795 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6796 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6797 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6798 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6799 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6800 action.
6801 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6802 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6803 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6804 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6805 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006806
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006807http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6808
6809 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6810 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6811 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6812 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6813 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006814 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006815 processing.
6816
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006817 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006818 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006819 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006820 rules evaluation.
6821
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006822http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6823http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006826 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6827 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6828 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6829 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6830 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6831 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6832
6833http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6834
6835 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6836 about <var-name>.
6837
6838 Example:
6839 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6840
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006841
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006842http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6843 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6844
6845 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6846 yes | no | yes | yes
6847
6848 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006849 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6850 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6851 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006852
6853 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6854
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006855 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6856 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6857 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6858 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6859 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6860 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6861 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6862 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6863 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6864 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006865
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006866 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6867 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6868 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6869 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6870 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6871 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6872 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006873 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6874 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6875 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6876 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6877 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6878 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006879
6880 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6881 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6882 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6883 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6884 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6885 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6886 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6887 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006888 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006889 downsides of rare connection failures.
6890
6891 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6892 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6893 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6894 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6895 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6896 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006897 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006898 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6899 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6900 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6901 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6902 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6903
6904 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006905 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6906 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6907 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006908
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006909 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6910 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6911 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006912
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006913 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6914 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006915
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006916 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006917
6918 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6919 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6920 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6921
6922 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6923
6924
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006925http-send-name-header [<header>]
6926 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6928 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006929 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006930 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6931
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006932 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6933 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6934 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6935 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6936 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6937 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6938 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6939 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6940 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6941 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6942 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6943 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6944 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6945 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6946 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6947 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006948
6949 See also : "server"
6950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006951id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006952 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6954 no | yes | yes | yes
6955 Arguments : none
6956
6957 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6958 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6959 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006960
6961
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006962ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6963 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006965 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006966
6967 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6968 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6969 and running).
6970
6971 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6972 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6973 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006974 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006975 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6976
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006977 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6978 "unless" condition is met.
6979
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006980 Example:
6981 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6982 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6983 ignore-persist if url_static
6984
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006985 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6986
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006987load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6988 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | no | yes | yes
6991
6992 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6993 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6994 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006995 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006996 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6997 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6998 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6999 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7000
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007001 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007002 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007003 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007004
7005 Arguments:
7006 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7007 named "server-state-file".
7008
7009 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7010 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7011 name is used as a file name.
7012
7013 none don't load any stat for this backend
7014
7015 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007016 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7017 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7018 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007019 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007020 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007021
7022 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7023 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7024
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007025 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007026
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007027 global
7028 stats socket /tmp/socket
7029 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007030
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007031 defaults
7032 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007033
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007034 backend bk
7035 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7036 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007037
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007038
7039 Then one can run :
7040
7041 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7042
7043 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7044
7045 1
7046 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7047 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7048 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7049
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007050 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007051
7052 global
7053 stats socket /tmp/socket
7054 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7055
7056 defaults
7057 load-server-state-from-file local
7058
7059 backend bk
7060 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7061 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7062
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007063
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007064 Then one can run :
7065
7066 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7067
7068 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7069
7070 1
7071 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7072 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7073 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7074
7075 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7076 "show servers state"
7077
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007078
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007079log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007080log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
7081 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007082no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007083 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7085 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007086
7087 Prefix :
7088 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7089 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7090 prefix does not allow arguments.
7091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007092 Arguments :
7093 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7094 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7095 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7096 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7097 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7098 parameter.
7099
7100 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7101 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7102
7103 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7104 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7105 standard syslog port).
7106
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007107 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7108 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7109 standard syslog port).
7110
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007111 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7112 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7113 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007114 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007115
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007116 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7117 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7118 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7119 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7120 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7121 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7122 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7123 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7124 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7125 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7126 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7127 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7128 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7129 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7130 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7131 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007132 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7133 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007134
7135 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7136 and "fd@2", see above.
7137
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007138 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7139 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7140 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7141 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7142 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7143 having the logs instantly available.
7144
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007145 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7146 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007147
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007148 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7149 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7150 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7151 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7152 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7153 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7154 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7155 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7156 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7157 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007158 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007159
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007160 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7161 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7162 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7163 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7164 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7165
7166 <sample_size>
7167 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7168 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7169 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7170 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7171 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7172
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007173 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7174 one of the following :
7175
7176 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
7177 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7178
7179 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7180 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7181
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007182 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7183 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7184 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7185 designed to be used with a local log server.
7186
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007187 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7188 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7189 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7190 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7191 systemd logger consumes.
7192
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007193 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7194 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7195 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7196 used with a local log server.
7197
7198 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7199 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7200 designed to be used with a local log server.
7201
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007202 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7203 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7204 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7205 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7206
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007207 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7208
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007209 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7210 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7211 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7212
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007213 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7214 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7215 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7216 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007217
7218 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7219 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7220 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007221 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7222 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7223 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7224 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7225 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007226
7227 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7228
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007229 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7230 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7231 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007232
7233 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7234 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7235 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7236 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7237
7238 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7239 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007240
7241 Example :
7242 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007243 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7244 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7245 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007246 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7247 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007248 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007250
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007251log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007252 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7254 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007255
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007256 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7257 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7258 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7259 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7260 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007261
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007262 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7263 "option httplog" directives.
7264
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007265log-format-sd <string>
7266 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7267 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7268 yes | yes | yes | no
7269
7270 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7271 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7272 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7273 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7274 which covers the log format string in depth.
7275
7276 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7277 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7278
7279 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7280 log format to "rfc5424".
7281
7282 Example :
7283 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7284
7285
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007286log-tag <string>
7287 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7288 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7289 yes | yes | yes | yes
7290
7291 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7292 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7293 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7294 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7295 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7296 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7297 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7298 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7299 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007300
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007301max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7302 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7304 yes | no | yes | yes
7305
7306 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7307 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7308 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7309 servers.
7310
7311 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7312 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7313 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7314 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7315 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007316 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007317 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7318 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7319 picking a different server.
7320
7321 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7322 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7323 even if they have to be queued.
7324
7325 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7326 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7327
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007328max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7329 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7330 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7331 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007332
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007333maxconn <conns>
7334 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 yes | yes | yes | no
7337 Arguments :
7338 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7339 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7340 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7341 closes.
7342
7343 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7344 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7345 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7346 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007347 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7348 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7349 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7350 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007351
7352 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7353 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7354 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7355
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007356 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7357 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007358
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007359 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7360
7361
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007362mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007363 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7365 yes | yes | yes | yes
7366 Arguments :
7367 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7368 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7369 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7370 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7371
7372 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7373 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7374 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7375 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7376 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7377
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007378 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7379 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7380 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007381
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007382 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007383 defaults http_instances
7384 mode http
7385
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007386
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007387monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007388 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7390 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007391 Arguments :
7392 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7393 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007394 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007395 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7396 backend and its backup.
7397
7398 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7399 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7400 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7401 servers in a list of backends.
7402
7403 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7404 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7405 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7406 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7407 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7408 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7409 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007410 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7411 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007412
7413 Example:
7414 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007415 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007416 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7417 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7418 monitor-uri /site_alive
7419 monitor fail if site_dead
7420
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007421 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007422
7423
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007424monitor-uri <uri>
7425 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7427 yes | yes | yes | no
7428 Arguments :
7429 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7430 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7431
7432 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7433 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7434 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7435 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7436 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7437 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7438 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7439 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7440
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007441 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007442 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7443 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7444 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7445 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7446 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7447 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007448
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007449 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7450 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7451 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7452 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7453
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007454 Example :
7455 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7456 frontend www
7457 mode http
7458 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7459
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007460 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007462
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007463option abortonclose
7464no option abortonclose
7465 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7467 yes | no | yes | yes
7468 Arguments : none
7469
7470 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7471 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7472 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7473 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007474 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007475 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7476 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7477 encountered while delivering the response.
7478
7479 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7480 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7481 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7482 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7483 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7484 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007485 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007486 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007487 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007488 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7489 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7490 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7491
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007492 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7493 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007494 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7495 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7496 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7497 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7498 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7499 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007500 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007501
7502 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7503 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7504
7505 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7506
7507
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007508option accept-invalid-http-request
7509no option accept-invalid-http-request
7510 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7512 yes | yes | yes | no
7513 Arguments : none
7514
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007515 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007516 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007517 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007518 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7519 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7520 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7521 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7522 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007523 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7524 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7525 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7526 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007527 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007528 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007529 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7530 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7531 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007532
7533 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7534 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7535 been confirmed.
7536
7537 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7538 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007539 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7540 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007541 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7542
7543 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7544 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7545
7546 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7547 stats socket.
7548
7549
7550option accept-invalid-http-response
7551no option accept-invalid-http-response
7552 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7554 yes | no | yes | yes
7555 Arguments : none
7556
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007557 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007558 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007559 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007560 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7561 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7562 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7563 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7564 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007565 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7566 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7567 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007568
7569 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7570 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7571 been confirmed.
7572
7573 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7574 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7575 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7576 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7577
7578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7580
7581 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7582 stats socket.
7583
7584
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007585option allbackups
7586no option allbackups
7587 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7589 yes | no | yes | yes
7590 Arguments : none
7591
7592 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7593 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7594 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7595 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7596 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7597 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7598 order between the backup servers anymore.
7599
7600 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7601 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7602
7603 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7604 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7605
7606
7607option checkcache
7608no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007609 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7611 yes | no | yes | yes
7612 Arguments : none
7613
7614 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7615 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007616 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007617 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7618 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007619 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007620
7621 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007622 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007623 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007624 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7625 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007626 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007627 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007628 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7629 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007630 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007631 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7632 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007633 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007634 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7635 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7636 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7637 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7638 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7639 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7640 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7641 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7642 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7643
7644 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007645 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7646 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7647 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7648 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007649
7650 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7651 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007652 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007653 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007654
7655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7657
7658
7659option clitcpka
7660no option clitcpka
7661 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7663 yes | yes | yes | no
7664 Arguments : none
7665
7666 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7667 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007668 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007669 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7670
7671 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7672 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7673 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7674 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7675
7676 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7677 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7678 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7679 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7680 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7681
7682 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7683
7684 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7685 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7686 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7687
7688 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7689 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7690
7691 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7692
7693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007694option contstats
7695 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7697 yes | yes | yes | no
7698 Arguments : none
7699
7700 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7701 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7702 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7703 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007704 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7705 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7706 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7707 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7708 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007709
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007710option disable-h2-upgrade
7711no option disable-h2-upgrade
7712 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7713 connection.
7714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7715 yes | yes | yes | no
7716 Arguments : none
7717
7718 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7719 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7720 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7721 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7722 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7723 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7724 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7725 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7726
7727 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7728 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007729
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007730option dontlog-normal
7731no option dontlog-normal
7732 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7734 yes | yes | yes | no
7735 Arguments : none
7736
7737 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7738 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7739 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7740 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7741 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7742 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7743 logged.
7744
7745 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7746 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7747 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007749 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007750 logging.
7751
7752
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007753option dontlognull
7754no option dontlognull
7755 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7757 yes | yes | yes | no
7758 Arguments : none
7759
7760 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7761 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7762 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7763 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7764 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7765 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007766 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7767 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7768 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007769
7770 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007771 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007772 would not be logged.
7773
7774 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7775 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7776
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007777 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007778 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007779
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007780
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007781option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007782 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7784 yes | yes | yes | yes
7785 Arguments :
7786 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7787 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007788 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007789 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007790
7791 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7792 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7793 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7794 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7795 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7796 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7797 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007798 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7799 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7800 possible that the client has already brought one.
7801
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007802 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007803 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007804 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007805 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007806 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007807 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007808
7809 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7810 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7811 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7812 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7813 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7814 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7815 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7816
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007817 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7818 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7819 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7820 are under the control of the end-user.
7821
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007822 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007823 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7824 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007825 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7826 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7827 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007828
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007829 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007830 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7831 frontend www
7832 mode http
7833 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7834
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007835 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7836 backend www
7837 mode http
7838 option forwardfor header X-Client
7839
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007840 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007841 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007842
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007843
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007844option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7845no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7846 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7848 yes | yes | yes | no
7849 Arguments : none
7850
7851 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7852 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7853 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7854 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7855 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7856 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7857 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7858
7859 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7860 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7861 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7862 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7863 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7864 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7865 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7866 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7867 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7868 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7869
7870 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7871
7872 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7873 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7874
7875 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7876 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7877
7878
7879option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7880no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7881 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7883 yes | no | yes | yes
7884 Arguments : none
7885
7886 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7887 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7888 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7889 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7890 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7891 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7892 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7893
7894 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7895 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7896 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7897 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7898 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7899 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7900 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7901 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7902 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7903 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7904
7905 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7906
7907 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7908 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7909
7910 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7911 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7912
7913
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007914option http-buffer-request
7915no option http-buffer-request
7916 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7918 yes | yes | yes | yes
7919 Arguments : none
7920
7921 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7922 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7923 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7924 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7925 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7926 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007927 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7928 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7929 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7930 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007931
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007932 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007933
7934
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007935option http-ignore-probes
7936no option http-ignore-probes
7937 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 yes | yes | yes | no
7940 Arguments : none
7941
7942 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7943 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7944 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7945 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7946 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7947 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7948 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7949 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7950 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007951 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7952 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007953 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7954
7955 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7956 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7957 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7958 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7959 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7960 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7961 are often the only way to detect them.
7962
7963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7965
7966 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7967
7968
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007969option http-keep-alive
7970no option http-keep-alive
7971 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7973 yes | yes | yes | yes
7974 Arguments : none
7975
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007976 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7977 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007978 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7979 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007980 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7981 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7982 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007983
7984 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7985 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007986 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7987 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7988 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7989 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7990 situations where this option may be useful :
7991
7992 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007993 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007994
7995 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7996 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7997
7998 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7999 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8000 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8001 request.
8002
8003 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8004 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008005 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8006 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8007 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008008
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008009 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8010 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8011 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8012 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8013 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8014 not set.
8015
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008016 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8017 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8018 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008019
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008020 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008021 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008022 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008023
8024
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008025option http-no-delay
8026no option http-no-delay
8027 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8029 yes | yes | yes | yes
8030 Arguments : none
8031
8032 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8033 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8034 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8035 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8036 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8037 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8038 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8039 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8040 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8041 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8042 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8043 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8044 affected.
8045
8046 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8047 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8048 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8049 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8050 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8051 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8052 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8053 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8054 latency environments.
8055
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008056 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8057
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008058
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008059option http-pretend-keepalive
8060no option http-pretend-keepalive
8061 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008063 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008064 Arguments : none
8065
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008066 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008067 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8068 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8069 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8070 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8071 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8072 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8073 consider the response complete.
8074
8075 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8076 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8077 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8078 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008079 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008080 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8081
8082 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8083 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8084 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8085 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8086 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8087 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8088 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8089
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008090 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8091 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8092 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8093 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8094 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8095 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008096
8097 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8098 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8099
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008100 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008101 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008102
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008103
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008104option http-server-close
8105no option http-server-close
8106 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8108 yes | yes | yes | yes
8109 Arguments : none
8110
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008111 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8112 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8113 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8114 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008115 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8116 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8117 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8118 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8119 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8120 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8121 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8122 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8123 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8124 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8125 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008126
8127 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8128 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8129 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8130 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008131 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8132 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008133
8134 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8135 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008136 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8137 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8138 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008139
8140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8142
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008143 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8144 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008145
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008146option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008147no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008148 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8150 yes | yes | yes | no
8151 Arguments : none
8152
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008153 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008154 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8155 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8156 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8157 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8158 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8159 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8160
8161 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8162 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008163 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8164 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8165 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008166
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008167 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8168 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8169 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8170 front of an existing proxy.
8171
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008172 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8173
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008174 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008175
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008176option httpchk
8177option httpchk <uri>
8178option httpchk <method> <uri>
8179option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008180 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8182 yes | no | yes | yes
8183 Arguments :
8184 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8185 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8186 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8187 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8188 ones.
8189
8190 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8191 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8192 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8193
8194 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8195 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8196 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008197 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008198
8199 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8200 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8201 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8202 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8203 the lack of any response.
8204
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008205 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8206 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8207 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8208 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8209
8210 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8211 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8212 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008213
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008214 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8215 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008216 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008217 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008218 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008219
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008220 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8221 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8222 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8223 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8224
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008225 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008226 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8227 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8228 backend https_relay
8229 mode tcp
8230 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8231 http-check send hdr Host www
8232 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008233
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008234 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8235 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8236 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008237
8238
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008239option httpclose
8240no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008241 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8243 yes | yes | yes | yes
8244 Arguments : none
8245
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008246 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8247 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8248 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8249 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008250 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008251
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008252 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8253 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008254 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008255 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8256 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008257
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008258 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8259 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8260 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008261
8262 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8263 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008264 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8265 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8266 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008267
8268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8270
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008271 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008272
8273
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008274option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008275 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008277 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008278 Arguments :
8279 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8280 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8281 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008282 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008283 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008284
8285 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8286 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8287 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8288 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8289 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8290 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8291 ports.
8292
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008293 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8294 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008295
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008296 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008298 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008299
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008300
8301option http_proxy
8302no option http_proxy
8303 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8305 yes | yes | yes | yes
8306 Arguments : none
8307
8308 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8309 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8310 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8311 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8312 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8313
8314 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8315 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008316 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8317 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008318
8319 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8320 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8321
8322 Example :
8323 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8324 backend direct_forward
8325 option httpclose
8326 option http_proxy
8327
8328 See also : "option httpclose"
8329
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008330
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008331option independent-streams
8332no option independent-streams
8333 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8335 yes | yes | yes | yes
8336 Arguments : none
8337
8338 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8339 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8340 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8341 receive data or not.
8342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008343 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008344 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8345 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8346 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8347 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8348 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8349 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8350 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8351 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8352 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8353 socket buffers.
8354
8355 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8356 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8357 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8358 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8359 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8360
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008361 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008362
8363
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008364option ldap-check
8365 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8367 yes | no | yes | yes
8368 Arguments : none
8369
8370 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8371 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8372 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8373 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8374
8375 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8376 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8377
8378 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8379 configure it.
8380
8381 Example :
8382 option ldap-check
8383
8384 See also : "option httpchk"
8385
8386
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008387option external-check
8388 Use external processes for server health checks
8389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8390 yes | no | yes | yes
8391
8392 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8393 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8394 command".
8395
8396 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8397
8398 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8399
8400
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008401option log-health-checks
8402no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008403 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8405 yes | no | yes | yes
8406 Arguments : none
8407
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008408 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8409 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8410 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008411
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008412 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8413 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8414 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8415 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8416 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8417
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008418 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008419 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008420
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008421 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8422 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8423 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008424
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008425
8426option log-separate-errors
8427no option log-separate-errors
8428 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8430 yes | yes | yes | no
8431 Arguments : none
8432
8433 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8434 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8435 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8436 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8437 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8438 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8439 provides very important information.
8440
8441 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8442 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8443 error logs.
8444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008445 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008446 logging.
8447
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008448
8449option logasap
8450no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008451 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8453 yes | yes | yes | no
8454 Arguments : none
8455
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008456 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8457 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8458 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8459 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8460
8461 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8462 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8463 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8464 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8465 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008466 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008467 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8468 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8469 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8470 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008471 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008472
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008473 Examples :
8474 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8475 mode http
8476 option httplog
8477 option logasap
8478 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8479
8480 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8481 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8482 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8483 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008485 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008486 logging.
8487
8488
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008489option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008490 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8492 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008493 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008494 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8495 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008496 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8497 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008498
8499 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8500 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008501 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008502 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8503 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8504 in the MySQL table, like this :
8505
8506 USE mysql;
8507 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8508 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8509
8510 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008511 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008512 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8513 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8514 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8515 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8516 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8517 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8518 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8519
8520 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8521 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008522
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008523 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008524
8525 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8526 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8527 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8528 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008529 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8530 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008531
8532 See also: "option httpchk"
8533
8534
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008535option nolinger
8536no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008537 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008538 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8539 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008540 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008541
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008542 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008543 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8544 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8545 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8546 connections.
8547
8548 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8549 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008550 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8551 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8552 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8553 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8554 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8555 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8556 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8557 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8558 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8559 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8560 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8561 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8562 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008563
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008564 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8565 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8566 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8567 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8568 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008569
8570 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8571 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008572 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8573 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8574 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008575
8576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8578
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008579 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8580 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008581
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008582option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8583 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8585 yes | yes | yes | yes
8586 Arguments :
8587 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8588 matching <network>
8589 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8590 header name.
8591
8592 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8593 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8594 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8595 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8596 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8597 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8598 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8599 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8600 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8601 possible that the client has already brought one.
8602
8603 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8604 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8605 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8606 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8607 header and requires different one.
8608
8609 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8610 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8611 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8612 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8613 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8614 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8615 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8616
8617 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8618 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8619 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8620 both are defined.
8621
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008622 Examples :
8623 # Original Destination address
8624 frontend www
8625 mode http
8626 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8627
8628 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8629 backend www
8630 mode http
8631 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8632
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008633 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008634
8635
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008636option persist
8637no option persist
8638 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8640 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008641 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008642
8643 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8644 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8645 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8646 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8647 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8648 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8649 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8650 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8651 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8652 redirected to another valid server.
8653
8654 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8655 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8656
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008657 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008658
8659
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008660option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8661 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8663 yes | no | yes | yes
8664 Arguments :
8665 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8666 PostgreSQL server.
8667
8668 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8669 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8670 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8671 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8672
8673 See also: "option httpchk"
8674
8675
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008676option prefer-last-server
8677no option prefer-last-server
8678 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8680 yes | no | yes | yes
8681 Arguments : none
8682
8683 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8684 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8685 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8686 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8687 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8688 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8689 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8690 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8691 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008692 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8693 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008694 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8695 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8696 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008697 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8698 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8699 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008700
8701 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8702 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8703
8704 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8705
8706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008707option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008708option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008709no option redispatch
8710 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8711 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8712 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008713 Arguments :
8714 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8715 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8716 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008717 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008718 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008719 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008720 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8721 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8722 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008724
8725 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8726 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8727 be able to access the service anymore.
8728
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008729 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8730 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008731
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008732 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8733 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8734 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8735 following order:
8736
8737 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8738
8739 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8740 list, or
8741
8742 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8743
8744 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8745 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8746
8747 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8748 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8749 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8750 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8751
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008752 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008753 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8754 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008756 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8757 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8758
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008759 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008760
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008761
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008762option redis-check
8763 Use redis health checks for server testing
8764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8765 yes | no | yes | yes
8766 Arguments : none
8767
8768 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8769 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8770 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8771 find the "+PONG" response message.
8772
8773 Example :
8774 option redis-check
8775
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008776 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008777
8778
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008779option smtpchk
8780option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8781 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8783 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008784 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008785 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008786 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008787 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8788
8789 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8790 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8791 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8792
8793 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8794 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8795 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8796 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8797 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8798 dead server.
8799
8800 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8801 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008802 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008803 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8804
8805 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8806 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8807 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8808 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008809 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008810
8811 Example :
8812 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8813
8814 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008817option socket-stats
8818no option socket-stats
8819
8820 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8822 yes | yes | yes | no
8823
8824 Arguments : none
8825
8826
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008827option splice-auto
8828no option splice-auto
8829 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8831 yes | yes | yes | yes
8832 Arguments : none
8833
8834 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8835 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008836 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008837 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008838 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008839 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8840 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8841 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8842 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8843
8844 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8845 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8846 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8847 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8848 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8849 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8850 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8851 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8852 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8853 keyword.
8854
8855 Example :
8856 option splice-auto
8857
8858 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8859 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8860
8861 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8862 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8863
8864
8865option splice-request
8866no option splice-request
8867 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8869 yes | yes | yes | yes
8870 Arguments : none
8871
8872 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008873 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008874 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8875 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8876 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8877 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8878
8879 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8880
8881 Example :
8882 option splice-request
8883
8884 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8885 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8886
8887 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8888 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8889
8890
8891option splice-response
8892no option splice-response
8893 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8895 yes | yes | yes | yes
8896 Arguments : none
8897
8898 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008899 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008900 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8901 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8902 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8903 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8904
8905 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8906
8907 Example :
8908 option splice-response
8909
8910 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8911 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8912
8913 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8914 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8915
8916
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008917option spop-check
8918 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8920 no | no | no | yes
8921 Arguments : none
8922
8923 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8924 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8925 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8926 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8927
8928 Example :
8929 option spop-check
8930
8931 See also : "option httpchk"
8932
8933
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008934option srvtcpka
8935no option srvtcpka
8936 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8938 yes | no | yes | yes
8939 Arguments : none
8940
8941 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8942 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008943 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008944 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8945
8946 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8947 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8948 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8949 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8950
8951 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8952 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8953 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8954 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8955 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8956
8957 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8958
8959 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8960 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8961 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8962
8963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8965
8966 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8967
8968
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008969option ssl-hello-chk
8970 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8972 yes | no | yes | yes
8973 Arguments : none
8974
8975 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8976 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8977 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8978 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8979 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8980 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8981 hello message.
8982
8983 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8984 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8985 messages, which is appreciable.
8986
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008987 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8988 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8989 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008990
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008991 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8992
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008993
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008994option tcp-check
8995 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8997 yes | no | yes | yes
8998
8999 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9000 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9001
9002 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9003 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9004 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9005
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009006 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009007 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9008 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9009 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9010 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9011 only.
9012
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009013 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009014 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9015 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9016 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9017 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9018
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009019 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009020 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9021 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009022 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009023 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9024 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9025 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9026 the respective protocols.
9027 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009028 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009029
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009030 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009031
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009032 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9033 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9034 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9035 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009036
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009037 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9038 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9039 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009040
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009041
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009042 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009043 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009044 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009045 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009046
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009047 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009048 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009049 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009050
9051 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9052 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009053 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009054 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009055 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009056 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009057 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009058 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009059 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9060 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009061 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009062 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9063 tcp-check expect string +OK
9064
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009065 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009066 (send many headers before analyzing)
9067 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009068 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009069 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9070 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9071 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9072 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009073 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009074
9075
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009076 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009077
9078
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009079option tcp-smart-accept
9080no option tcp-smart-accept
9081 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9083 yes | yes | yes | no
9084 Arguments : none
9085
9086 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9087 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9088 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9089 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9090 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9091 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9092
9093 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9094 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9095 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9096 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9097
9098 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9099 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9100 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009101 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009102
9103 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9104 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9105 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9106
9107 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9108 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9109 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9110
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009111 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9112
9113
9114option tcp-smart-connect
9115no option tcp-smart-connect
9116 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9118 yes | no | yes | yes
9119 Arguments : none
9120
9121 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9122 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9123 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9124 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9125 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9126
9127 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9128 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9129 complex.
9130
9131 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9132 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9133 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9134
9135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9137
9138 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9139
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009140
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009141option tcpka
9142 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9144 yes | yes | yes | yes
9145 Arguments : none
9146
9147 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9148 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009149 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009150 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9151
9152 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9153 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9154 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9155 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9156
9157 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9158 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9159 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9160 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9161 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9162
9163 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9164
9165 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9166 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9167 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9168 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9169 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9170 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9171 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9172 backends.
9173
9174 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9175
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009176
9177option tcplog
9178 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009180 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009181 Arguments : none
9182
9183 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9184 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9185 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9186 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9187 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9188 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9189 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9190 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9191
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009192 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009194 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009195
9196
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009197option transparent
9198no option transparent
9199 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009201 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009202 Arguments : none
9203
9204 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9205 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9206 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9207 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9208 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9209 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9210 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9211 appropriate server.
9212
9213 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9214 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9215
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009216 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009217 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009218
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009219
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009220external-check command <command>
9221 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9223 yes | no | yes | yes
9224
9225 Arguments :
9226 <command> is the external command to run
9227
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009228 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9229
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009230 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009231
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009232 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9233 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9234 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9235 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9236 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9237 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009238
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009239 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9240
9241 Environment variables :
9242 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9243 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9244
9245 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9246
9247 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9248
9249 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9250 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9251 for a UNIX socket).
9252
9253 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9254
9255 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9256
9257 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9258
9259 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9260
9261 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9262
9263 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9264 socket).
9265
9266 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9267 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9268
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009269 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9270
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009271 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9272 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9273 failed.
9274
9275 Example :
9276 external-check command /bin/true
9277
9278 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9279
9280
9281external-check path <path>
9282 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9284 yes | no | yes | yes
9285
9286 Arguments :
9287 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9288
9289 The default path is "".
9290
9291 Example :
9292 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9293
9294 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9295 "external-check command"
9296
9297
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009298persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009299persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009300 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9302 yes | no | yes | yes
9303 Arguments :
9304 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009305 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9306 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009307
9308 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9309 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009310 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009311 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9312 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9313 forwarded to this server.
9314
9315 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9316 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9317 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009318 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009319 a single "listen" section.
9320
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009321 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9322 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9323 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9324
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009325 Example :
9326 listen tse-farm
9327 bind :3389
9328 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9329 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9330 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9331 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9332 persist rdp-cookie
9333 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009334 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009335 balance rdp-cookie
9336 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9337 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9338
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009339 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9340 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009341
9342
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009343rate-limit sessions <rate>
9344 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9346 yes | yes | yes | no
9347 Arguments :
9348 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9349 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9350
9351 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9352 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9353 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9354 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9355 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9356 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9357
9358 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9359 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9360 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9361 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9362
9363 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9364 listen smtp
9365 mode tcp
9366 bind :25
9367 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009368 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009369
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009370 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9371 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9372 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009373
9374 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9375
9376
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009377redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9378redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9379redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009380 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9382 no | yes | yes | yes
9383
9384 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009385 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009386
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009387 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009388 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009389 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9390 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9391 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009392
9393 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9394 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9395 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9396 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9397 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009398 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9399 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9400 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9401 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009402
9403 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9404 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9405 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9406 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9407 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9408 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009409 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009410 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009411 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9412 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9413 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009414
9415 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009416 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9417 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9418 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009419 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009420 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9421 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9422 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9423 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009424
9425 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009426 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009427
9428 - "drop-query"
9429 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9430 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9431 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9432 with a location-type redirect.
9433
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009434 - "append-slash"
9435 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9436 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9437 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9438 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9439
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009440 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9441 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9442 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9443 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9444 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9445 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9446 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9447
9448 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9449 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9450 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9451 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9452 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9453 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9454 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009455
9456 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9457 acl clear dst_port 80
9458 acl secure dst_port 8080
9459 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009460 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009461 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009462 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9463
9464 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009465 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9466 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9467 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009468 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009469
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009470 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9471 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9472 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9473
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009474 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009475 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009476
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009477 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009478 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9479 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9480 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009482 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009483
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009484
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009485retries <value>
9486 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9487 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9488 yes | no | yes | yes
9489 Arguments :
9490 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9491 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9492 default value is 3.
9493
9494 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9495 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9496 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9497
9498 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009499 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9500 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009501
9502 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9503 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9504
9505 See also : "option redispatch"
9506
9507
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009508retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009509 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9510 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9511 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009512 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9513 yes | no | yes | yes
9514 Arguments :
9515 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9516 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9517 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9518 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9519
9520 none never retry
9521
9522 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9523 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9524
9525 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9526 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9527 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9528 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9529 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9530 processing the request.
9531
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009532 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9533 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9534 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9535 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9536 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9537 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9538 overflow attack for example).
9539
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009540 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9541 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9542 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9543 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9544 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9545 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9546 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9547 amplify denial of service attacks.
9548
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009549 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9550 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9551 considered to be safe to retry.
9552
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009553 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9554 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9555 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9556 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9557 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009558
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009559 all-retryable-errors
9560 retry request for any error that are considered
9561 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9562 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9563 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9564
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009565 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9566 not cumulative.
9567
9568 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9569 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9570 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9571 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9572
9573 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9574 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9575 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9576 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9577 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9578 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9579 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9580 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9581 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9582 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9583 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9584 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9585
9586 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9587 should not use this directive.
9588
9589 The default is "conn-failure".
9590
9591 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9592
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009593server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009594 Declare a server in a backend
9595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9596 no | no | yes | yes
9597 Arguments :
9598 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009599 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009600 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009601
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009602 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9603 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9604 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9605 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009606 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9607 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9608 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9609 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9610 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009611 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9612 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9613 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9614 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9615 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9616 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9617 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009618 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009619 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9620 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9621 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9622 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9623 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9624 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009625 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9626 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009627 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9628 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009629
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009630 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009631 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9632 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9633 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9634 adding this value to the client's port.
9635
9636 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9637 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009638 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009639
9640 Examples :
9641 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9642 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009643 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009644 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9645 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9646 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009647
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009648 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9649 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9650 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9651 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9652 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9653
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009654 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9655 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009656
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009657server-state-file-name [<file>]
9658 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9659 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9660 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9661 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9662 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9663 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9664
9665 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9666 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9667
9668 global
9669 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9670
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009671 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009672 load-server-state-from-file
9673
9674 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9675 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009676
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009677server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9678 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9679 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9681 no | no | yes | yes
9682
9683 Arguments:
9684 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9685
9686 <num | range>
9687 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9688 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9689 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9690 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9691
9692 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9693
9694 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9695
9696 <params*>
9697 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9698 keyword.
9699
9700 Examples:
9701 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9702 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9703 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9704
9705 # or
9706 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9707
9708 # would be equivalent to:
9709 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9710 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9711 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9712
9713
9714
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009715source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009716source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009717source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009718 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9720 yes | no | yes | yes
9721 Arguments :
9722 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9723 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009724
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009725 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009726 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9727 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9728 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9729 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9730 supported prefixes are :
9731 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9732 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9733 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009734 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009735 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9736 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009737
9738 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9739 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009740 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9741 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9742 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009743
9744 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9745 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9746 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9747 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9748 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9749 <addr>.
9750
9751 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9752 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9753 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9754 port.
9755
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009756 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9757 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9758 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9759 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009760 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009761 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9762 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9763 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9764 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9765 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9766 HTTP header.
9767
9768 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9769 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009770 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009771 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9772 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9773 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9774 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9775 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9776 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9777 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9778
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009779 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9780 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9781 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9782 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9783 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9784 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9785
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009786 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9787 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9788 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9789 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9790
9791 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9792 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9793 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9794 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9795 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9796 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9797
9798 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9799 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9800 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9801 there are two methods :
9802
9803 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9804 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9805 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9806 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9807 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9808 of the client ranges may be used.
9809
9810 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9811 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9812 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9813 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9814 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9815 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9816 same session.
9817
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009818 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9819 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9820 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009821 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009822
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009823 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9824
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009825 Examples :
9826 backend private
9827 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9828 source 192.168.1.200
9829
9830 backend transparent_ssl1
9831 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9832 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9833
9834 backend transparent_ssl2
9835 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9836 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9837 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9838
9839 backend transparent_ssl3
9840 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9841 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9842 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9843
9844 backend transparent_smtp
9845 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9846 # with Tproxy version 4.
9847 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9848
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009849 backend transparent_http
9850 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9851 # proxy.
9852 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009854 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009855 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9856
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009857
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009858srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9859 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9860 the connection on the server side.
9861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9862 yes | no | yes | yes
9863 Arguments :
9864 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9865
9866 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9867 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009868 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9869 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009870
9871 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9872
9873
9874srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9875 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9876 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9877 server side.
9878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9879 yes | no | yes | yes
9880 Arguments :
9881 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9882 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9883 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9884 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9885
9886 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9887 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009888 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9889 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009890
9891 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9892
9893
9894srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9895 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9897 yes | no | yes | yes
9898 Arguments :
9899 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9900 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9901 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9902 document.
9903
9904 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9905 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009906 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9907 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009908
9909 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9910
9911
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009912stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9913 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009915 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009916
9917 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9918 matched.
9919
9920 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9921 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9922
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009923 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9924 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009925 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009926
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009927 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9928 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9929 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9930 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009931
9932 Example :
9933 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9934 backend stats_localhost
9935 stats enable
9936 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9937
9938 Example :
9939 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9940 backend stats_auth
9941 stats enable
9942 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9943 stats admin if TRUE
9944
9945 Example :
9946 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9947 userlist stats-auth
9948 group admin users admin
9949 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9950 group readonly users haproxy
9951 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9952
9953 backend stats_auth
9954 stats enable
9955 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9956 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9957 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9958 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9959
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009960 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9961 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9962 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009963
9964
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009965stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9966 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009968 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009969 Arguments :
9970 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9971
9972 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9973
9974 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9975 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9976 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9977 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9978 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9979 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9980
9981 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9982 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9983 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009984 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009985
9986 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9987 report using "stats scope".
9988
9989 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9990 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9991 unobvious parameters.
9992
9993 Example :
9994 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9995 backend public_www
9996 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9997 stats enable
9998 stats hide-version
9999 stats scope .
10000 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010001 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010002 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10003 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10004
10005 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10006 backend private_monitoring
10007 stats enable
10008 stats uri /admin?stats
10009 stats refresh 5s
10010
10011 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10012
10013
10014stats enable
10015 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010017 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010018 Arguments : none
10019
10020 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10021 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10022 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10023 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10024 - stats auth : no authentication
10025 - stats scope : no restriction
10026
10027 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10028 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10029 unobvious parameters.
10030
10031 Example :
10032 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10033 backend public_www
10034 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10035 stats enable
10036 stats hide-version
10037 stats scope .
10038 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010039 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010040 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10041 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10042
10043 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10044 backend private_monitoring
10045 stats enable
10046 stats uri /admin?stats
10047 stats refresh 5s
10048
10049 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10050
10051
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010052stats hide-version
10053 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010055 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010056 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010057
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010058 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10059 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10060 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10061 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10062 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10063 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010065 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10066 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10067 unobvious parameters.
10068
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010069 Example :
10070 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10071 backend public_www
10072 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010073 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010074 stats hide-version
10075 stats scope .
10076 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010077 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010078 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10079 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010080
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010081 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10082 backend private_monitoring
10083 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010084 stats uri /admin?stats
10085 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010086
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010087 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010088
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010089
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010090stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10091 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10092 Access control for statistics
10093
10094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10095 no | no | yes | yes
10096
10097 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10098 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10099 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10100 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10101 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10102 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10103
10104 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10105 instance.
10106
10107 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10108 about ACL usage.
10109
10110
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010111stats realm <realm>
10112 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010114 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010115 Arguments :
10116 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10117 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10118 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10119
10120 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10121 using a backslash ('\').
10122
10123 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10124 only related to authentication.
10125
10126 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10127 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10128 unobvious parameters.
10129
10130 Example :
10131 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10132 backend public_www
10133 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10134 stats enable
10135 stats hide-version
10136 stats scope .
10137 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010138 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010139 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10140 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10141
10142 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10143 backend private_monitoring
10144 stats enable
10145 stats uri /admin?stats
10146 stats refresh 5s
10147
10148 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10149
10150
10151stats refresh <delay>
10152 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010154 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010155 Arguments :
10156 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10157 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10158 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10159 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10160 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10161 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10162
10163 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10164 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10165 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010166 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010167
10168 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10169 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10170 unobvious parameters.
10171
10172 Example :
10173 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10174 backend public_www
10175 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10176 stats enable
10177 stats hide-version
10178 stats scope .
10179 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010180 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010181 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10182 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10183
10184 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10185 backend private_monitoring
10186 stats enable
10187 stats uri /admin?stats
10188 stats refresh 5s
10189
10190 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10191
10192
10193stats scope { <name> | "." }
10194 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010196 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010197 Arguments :
10198 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10199 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10200 section in which the statement appears.
10201
10202 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10203 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10204 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10205 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10206 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10207 exists.
10208
10209 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10210 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10211 unobvious parameters.
10212
10213 Example :
10214 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10215 backend public_www
10216 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10217 stats enable
10218 stats hide-version
10219 stats scope .
10220 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010221 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010222 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10223 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10224
10225 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10226 backend private_monitoring
10227 stats enable
10228 stats uri /admin?stats
10229 stats refresh 5s
10230
10231 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10232
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010233
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010234stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010235 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010237 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010238
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010239 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010240 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10241
10242 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10243 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10244
10245 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10246 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010247 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010248
10249 Example :
10250 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10251 backend private_monitoring
10252 stats enable
10253 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10254 stats uri /admin?stats
10255 stats refresh 5s
10256
10257 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10258 global section.
10259
10260
10261stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010262 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10264 yes | yes | yes | yes
10265 Arguments : none
10266
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010267 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010268 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10269 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10270 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10271 - IP (socket, server)
10272 - cookie (backend, server)
10273
10274 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10275 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010276 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010277
10278 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10279
10280
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010281stats show-modules
10282 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10284 yes | yes | yes | yes
10285 Arguments : none
10286
10287 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10288 values as a tooltip.
10289
10290 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10291 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10292 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10293
10294 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10295
10296
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010297stats show-node [ <name> ]
10298 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010300 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010301 Arguments:
10302 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10303 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10304
10305 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10306 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010307 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010308
10309 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10310 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10311 unobvious parameters.
10312
10313 Example:
10314 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10315 backend private_monitoring
10316 stats enable
10317 stats show-node Europe-1
10318 stats uri /admin?stats
10319 stats refresh 5s
10320
10321 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10322 section.
10323
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010324
10325stats uri <prefix>
10326 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010328 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010329 Arguments :
10330 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10331 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10332 query string.
10333
10334 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10335 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10336 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10337 possible to reach it in the application.
10338
10339 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010340 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010341 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10342 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10343 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10344 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10345
10346 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10347 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10348 an address or a port to statistics only.
10349
10350 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10351 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10352 unobvious parameters.
10353
10354 Example :
10355 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10356 backend public_www
10357 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10358 stats enable
10359 stats hide-version
10360 stats scope .
10361 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010362 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010363 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10364 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10365
10366 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10367 backend private_monitoring
10368 stats enable
10369 stats uri /admin?stats
10370 stats refresh 5s
10371
10372 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10373
10374
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010375stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10376 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010378 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010379
10380 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010381 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010382 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010383 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010384 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10385
10386 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10387 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10388 the "stick-table" statement.
10389
10390 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10391 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10392 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10393 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10394 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10395
10396 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10397 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10398 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10399 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10400 transformation rules.
10401
10402 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10403 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10404 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10405 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10406 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10407 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10408 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10409
10410 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10411 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10412 ACL based conditions.
10413
10414 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10415 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10416 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10417 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10418
10419 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10420 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10421 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10422 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10423
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010424 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10425 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010426 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010427
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010428 Example :
10429 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10430 # last 30 minutes
10431 backend pop
10432 mode tcp
10433 balance roundrobin
10434 stick store-request src
10435 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10436 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10437 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10438
10439 backend smtp
10440 mode tcp
10441 balance roundrobin
10442 stick match src table pop
10443 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10444 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10445
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010446 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010447 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010448
10449
10450stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10451 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10453 no | no | yes | yes
10454
10455 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10456 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10457 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10458 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10459
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010460 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10461 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010462 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010463
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010464 Examples :
10465 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010466 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010467
10468 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10469 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10470 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10471
10472
10473 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10474 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10475 backend http
10476 mode http
10477 balance roundrobin
10478 stick on src table https
10479 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10480 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10481 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10482
10483 backend https
10484 mode tcp
10485 balance roundrobin
10486 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10487 stick on src
10488 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10489 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10490
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010491 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010492
10493
10494stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10495 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10497 no | no | yes | yes
10498
10499 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010500 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010501 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010502 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010503 server is selected.
10504
10505 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10506 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10507 the "stick-table" statement.
10508
10509 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10510 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10511 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10512 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10513 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10514 address.
10515
10516 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10517 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10518 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10519 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10520 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10521 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10522 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10523 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10524 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10525 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10526
10527 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10528 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10529 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10530 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10531 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10532 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10533 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10534
10535 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10536 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10537 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10538 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10539
10540 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10541 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10542 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10543 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10544 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10545 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010546 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10547 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10548 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10549 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10550 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10551 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010552
10553 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10554 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10555 the request.
10556
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010557 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10558 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010559 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010560
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010561 Example :
10562 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10563 # last 30 minutes
10564 backend pop
10565 mode tcp
10566 balance roundrobin
10567 stick store-request src
10568 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10569 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10570 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10571
10572 backend smtp
10573 mode tcp
10574 balance roundrobin
10575 stick match src table pop
10576 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10577 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10578
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010579 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010580 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010581
10582
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010583stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010584 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10585 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010586 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010588 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010589
10590 Arguments :
10591 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10592 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10593 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10594 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10595
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010596 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10597 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10598 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10599 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10600
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010601 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10602 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10603 instance.
10604
10605 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10606 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10607 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10608 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10609 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10610 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010611 to 32 characters.
10612
10613 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10614 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10615 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010616 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010617 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10618 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010619
10620 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010621 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10622 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010623 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10624 increase.
10625
10626 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010627 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10628 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10629 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010630
10631 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10632 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10633 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10634 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010635 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010636 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10637 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10638 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10639 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10640 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10641 parameter (see below).
10642
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010643 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10644 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10645 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10646 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10647 soft restart.
10648
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010649 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10650 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010651
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010652 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10653 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10654 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10655 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010656 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010657 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010658 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10659 if not expiration delay is specified.
10660
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010661 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10662 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10663 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10664 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010665 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10666 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10667 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10668 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10669 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10670 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10671 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10672 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10673 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10674 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10675 types and their arguments.
10676
10677 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10678 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10679 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10680 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10681
10682 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10683 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10684 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010685 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010686
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010687 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10688 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10689 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010690 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010691 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010692 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010693
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010694 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10695 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10696 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10697 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10698
10699 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10700 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10701 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10702 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10703 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10704 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10705
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010706 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10707 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10708 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10709 they were received.
10710
10711 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10712 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10713 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10714 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10715 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10716
10717 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10718 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10719 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10720 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10721 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10722
10723 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10724 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10725 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10726
10727 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10728 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10729 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10730 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10731 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10732
10733 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10734 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10735 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10736 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10737 the client side.
10738
10739 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10740 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10741 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10742 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10743 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10744 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10745 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10746
10747 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10748 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10749 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10750 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10751 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10752 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010753 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010754
10755 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10756 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10757 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10758 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10759 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10760 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10761
10762 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010763 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010764 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10765 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10766
10767 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10768 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10769 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10770 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10771 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10772 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10773 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10774 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10775 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10776 recommended for better fairness.
10777
10778 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010779 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010780 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10781 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10782
10783 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10784 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10786 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10787 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10788 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10789 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10790 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10791 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10792 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010793
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010794 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10795 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010796 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10797 reference it.
10798
10799 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10800 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010801 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10802 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10803 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010804
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010805 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10806 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10807 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10808 something that can be ignored.
10809
10810 Example:
10811 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10812 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10813 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10814 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10815
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010816 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010817 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010818
10819
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010820stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010821 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10823 no | no | yes | yes
10824
10825 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010826 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010827 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010828 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010829 server is selected.
10830
10831 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10832 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10833 the "stick-table" statement.
10834
10835 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10836 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10837 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10838 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10839
10840 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10841 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10842 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10843 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10844 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10845 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010846 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010847 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10848 rules.
10849
10850 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10851 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10852 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10853 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10854 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10855 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10856 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10857
10858 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10859 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10860 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10861 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10862
10863 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10864 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10865 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10866 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10867 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10868 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010869 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10870 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10871 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10872 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10873 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10874 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10875 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10876 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10877 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010878
10879 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10880
10881 Example :
10882 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10883 backend https
10884 mode tcp
10885 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010886 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010887 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010888
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010889 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10890 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10891
10892 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10893 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10894 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10895
10896 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10897 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010898
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010899 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10900 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10901 # at offset 44.
10902
10903 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10904 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10905
10906 # Learn on response if server hello.
10907 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010908
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010909 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10910 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10911
10912 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10913 extraction.
10914
10915
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010916tcp-check comment <string>
10917 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10918 it fails.
10919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10920 yes | no | yes | yes
10921
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010922 Arguments :
10923 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10924 rule fails.
10925
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010926 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10927 user-friendly error reporting.
10928
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010929 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10930 "tcp-check expect".
10931
10932
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010933tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10934 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010935 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010936 Opens a new connection
10937 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010938 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010939
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010940 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010941 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10942
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010943 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010944 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010945
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010946 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010947 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10948 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010949 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010950
10951 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010952
10953 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10954
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010955 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10956
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010957 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10958
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010959 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10960
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010961 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10962 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10963 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10964 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10965
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010966 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10967 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10968 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10969 haproxy -vv.
10970
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010971 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010972
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010973 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10974 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10975 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10976
10977 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10978 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10979 of the sequence.
10980
10981 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10982 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10983 do.
10984
10985 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10986 unset-var or comment rules.
10987
10988 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010989 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10990 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10991 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10992 option tcp-check
10993 tcp-check connect
10994 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10995 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10996 tcp-check send \r\n
10997 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10998 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10999 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11000 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11001 tcp-check send \r\n
11002 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11003 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11004
11005 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11006 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011007 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011008 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11009 tcp-check connect port 143
11010 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11011 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11012
11013 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11014
11015
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011016tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011017 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011018 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011019 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011020 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011022 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011023
11024 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011025 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11026
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011027 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11028 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11029 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11030 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11031 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11032 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11033 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11034 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11035 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11036 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11037
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011038 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011039 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11040 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011041 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11042 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11043 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11044
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011045 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11046 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11047 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011048 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11049 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011050 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11051 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011052 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11053 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011054 By default "L7OK" is used.
11055
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011056 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11057 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011058 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11059 supported :
11060 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11061 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011062 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11063 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11064 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11065 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11066 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011067
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011068 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011069 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011070 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11071 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11072 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11073 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011074 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11075
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011076 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11077 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11078 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11079 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11080
11081 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11082 informational message reported in logs if an error
11083 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11084 log-format string.
11085
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011086 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11087 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11088 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11089 followed by some converters.
11090
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011091 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11092 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11093 with the usual backslash ('\').
11094 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011095 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011096 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11097 used upper or lower case.
11098
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011099 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11100
11101 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11102 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11103 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11104 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11105 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11106 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11107 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11108 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11109
11110 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11111 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11112 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11113 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11114 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11115 expression.
11116
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011117 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11118 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11119 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11120 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11121 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11122 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11123
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011124 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11125 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11126 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11127 this exact hexadecimal string.
11128 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11129
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011130 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11131 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11132 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11133 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11134 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11135 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11136 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11137 size.
11138
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011139 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11140 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11141 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11142 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11143 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11144 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11145 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11146 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11147 in a binary string before matching the response's
11148 buffer.
11149
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011150 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011151 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011152 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11153 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11154 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11155 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11156 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11157 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11158 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11159 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11160 the null character.
11161
11162 Examples :
11163 # perform a POP check
11164 option tcp-check
11165 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11166
11167 # perform an IMAP check
11168 option tcp-check
11169 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11170
11171 # look for the redis master server
11172 option tcp-check
11173 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011174 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011175 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11176 tcp-check expect string role:master
11177 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11178 tcp-check expect string +OK
11179
11180
11181 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011182 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011183
11184
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011185tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11186tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11187 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11188 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011189 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011190 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011191
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011192 Arguments :
11193 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11194
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011195 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11196 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011197
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011198 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11199 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011200
11201 Examples :
11202 # look for the redis master server
11203 option tcp-check
11204 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11205 tcp-check expect string role:master
11206
11207 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011208 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011209
11210
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011211tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11212tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11213 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11214 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011215 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011216 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011217
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011218 Arguments :
11219 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011220
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011221 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11222 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011223
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011224 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11225 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11226 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011227
11228 Examples :
11229 # redis check in binary
11230 option tcp-check
11231 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11232 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11233
11234
11235 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011236 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011237
11238
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011239tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011240 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011242 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011243
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011244 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011245 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11246 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11247 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11248 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11249 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11250 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11251 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11252 and '-'.
11253
11254 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11255
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011256 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011257 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11258
11259
11260tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011261 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011262 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011263 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011264
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011265 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011266 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11267 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11268 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11269 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11270 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11271 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11272 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11273 and '-'.
11274
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011275 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011276 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11277
11278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011279tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11280 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11282 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011283 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011284 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11285 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011287 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011288
11289 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11290 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011291 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11292 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11293 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11294 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11295 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11296 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011298 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11299 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11300 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11301 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011302
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011303 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011304 - accept :
11305 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11306 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11307 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011309 - reject :
11310 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11311 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11312 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11313 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11314 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11315 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11316 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11317 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11318 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11319 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11320 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011321 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011322
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011323 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11324 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11325 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11326 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11327 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11328 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11329 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11330 hosts.
11331
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011332 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11333 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11334 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11335 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11336 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11337 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11338 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11339 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11340
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011341 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11342 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11343 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11344 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11345 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11346 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11347 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11348 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11349 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011350 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11351 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011352
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011353 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011354 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011355 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11356 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11357 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011358 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011359 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011360 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11361 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11362 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11363 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11364 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11365 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11366 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011367
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011368 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011369 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011370 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011371 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011372 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11373 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11374 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011375
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011376 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11377 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11378 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11379 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011380
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011381 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11382 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11383 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11384 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11385 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011386 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11387 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11388 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11389 layer7 information is extracted.
11390
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011391 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11392 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11393 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11394 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11395 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011396
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011397 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11398 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11399 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11400 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11401
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011402 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11403 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11404 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11405 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11406
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011407 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11408 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11409 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11410 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11411 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011412
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011413 - set-src <expr> :
11414 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11415 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11416 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011417 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011418
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011419 Arguments:
11420 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11421 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011422
11423 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011424 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11425
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011426 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11427 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011428
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011429 - set-src-port <expr> :
11430 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11431 expression.
11432
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011433 Arguments:
11434 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11435 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011436
11437 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011438 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11439
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011440 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11441 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11442 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011443
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011444 - set-dst <expr> :
11445 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11446 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11447 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11448 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11449 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11450
11451 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11452 followed by some converters.
11453
11454 Example:
11455
11456 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11457 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11458
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011459 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11460 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11461
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011462 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11463 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11464 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11465 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11466
11467
11468 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11469 followed by some converters.
11470
11471 Example:
11472
11473 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11474
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011475 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11476 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11477 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11478
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011479 - "silent-drop" :
11480 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011481 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011482 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11483 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11484 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11485 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11486 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011487 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11488 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011489 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11490 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011491 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011492 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11493 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11494 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11495 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11496
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011497 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11498 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11499 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011500
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011501 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11502 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11503 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011504
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011505 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011506 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011507 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011509 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11510 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11511 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011512
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011513 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011514 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11515 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011516
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011517 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11518
11519 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11520
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011521 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11522
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011523 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011524
11525
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011526tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11527 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011529 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011530 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011531 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11532 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011534 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011535
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011536 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011537 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11538 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11539 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11540 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011541
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011542 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11543 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11544 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11545 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011546 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11547 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11548 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11549 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11550 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11551 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011552 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011553 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011554
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011555 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11556 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11557 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11558 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011559
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011560 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011561 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011562 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011563 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11564 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011565 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011566 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011567 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011568 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011569 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011570 - set-dst <expr>
11571 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011572 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011573 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011574 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011575 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011576 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011577
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011578 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11579 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011580 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11581 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011582
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011583 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11584 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11585 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11586 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11587 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11588 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011590 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011591 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11592 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011593
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011594 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11595 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11596 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11597 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11598 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11599 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11600
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011601 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011602 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11603 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11604 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11605 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11606 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11607 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11608 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11609 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11610 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11611 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011612
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011613 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011614 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11615 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11616 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011617
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011618 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11619 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11620
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011621 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011622 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11623 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011624
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011625 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11626 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011627 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011628 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11629 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011630 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011631 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011632 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011633 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11634 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011635 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011636 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11637 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011638
11639 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11640 followed by some converters.
11641
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011642 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11643 <var-name>.
11644
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011645 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11646 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11647 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11648 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11649 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11650
11651 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11652 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11653 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11654 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11655 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11656 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11657 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11658 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11659 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11660 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11661 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11662
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011663 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11664 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11665 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11666 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11667 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11668
11669 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11670
11671 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11672
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011673 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11674 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11675 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11676 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11677 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11678 evaluated.
11679
11680 Example:
11681 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11682
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011683 Example:
11684
11685 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011686 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011687
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011688 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011689 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11690 # and reject everything else.
11691 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11692 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011693 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011694 tcp-request content reject
11695
11696 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011697 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11698 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11699 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011700 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011701
11702 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11703 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11704 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011705 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011706 tcp-request content reject
11707
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011708 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011709 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011710 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011711 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011712 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11713 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011714
11715 Example:
11716 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11717 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011718 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011719
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011720 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011721 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011722
11723 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011724 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011725 # protecting all our sites
11726 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011727 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11728 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011729 ...
11730 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11731
11732 backend http_dynamic
11733 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011734 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011735 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011736 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011737 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011738 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011739 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011741 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011742
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011743 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11744 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011745
11746
11747tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11748 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011750 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011751 Arguments :
11752 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11753 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11754 as explained at the top of this document.
11755
11756 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11757 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11758 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11759 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11760 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11761
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011762 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11763 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11764 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11765 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11766
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011767 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11768 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011769 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011770 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011771 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11772 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11773 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11774 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011775
11776 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11777 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11778 it pass through unaffected.
11779
11780 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11781 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11782 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011783 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011784 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11785 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011786 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11787 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11788 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011789
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011790 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011791 "timeout client".
11792
11793
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011794tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11795 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11797 no | no | yes | yes
11798 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011799 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11800 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011801
11802 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11803
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011804 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011805 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11806 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011807 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11808 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011809
11810 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11811
11812 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11813 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11814 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11815 inserted.
11816
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011817 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011818 - accept :
11819 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11820 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11821 the rules evaluation.
11822
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011823 - close :
11824 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11825 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11826 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11827 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11828 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11829 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011830 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011831 protocols.
11832
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011833 - reject :
11834 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11835 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011836 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011837
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011838 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11839 Sets a variable.
11840
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011841 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11842 Unsets a variable.
11843
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011844 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11845 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11846 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11847 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11848
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011849 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11850 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11851 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11852 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11853
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011854 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11855 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11856 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11857 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11858 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011859
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011860 - "silent-drop" :
11861 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011862 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011863 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11864 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11865 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11866 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11867 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011868 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11869 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011870 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11871 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011872 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011873 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11874 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11875 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11876 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11877
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011878 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11879 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11880
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011881 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11882 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11883 for changing the default action to a reject.
11884
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011885 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11886 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11887 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11888 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011889 period.
11890
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011891 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11892 declared inline.
11893
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011894 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11895 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011896 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011897 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11898 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011899 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011900 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011901 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011902 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11903 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011904 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011905 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11906 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011907
11908 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11909 followed by some converters.
11910
11911 Example:
11912
11913 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11914
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011915 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11916 <var-name>.
11917
11918 Example:
11919
11920 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11921
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011922 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11923 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11924 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11925 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11926 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11927
11928 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11929
11930 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11931
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011932 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11933
11934 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11935
11936
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011937tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11938 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11940 no | yes | yes | no
11941 Arguments :
11942 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11943 below.
11944
11945 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11946
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011947 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011948 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11949 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11950 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11951 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11952 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11953 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11954 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011955 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011956 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11957 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11958 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11959 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11960 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11961 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11962 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11963 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11964 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11965 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11966 instead.
11967
11968 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11969 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11970 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11971 rules which may be inserted.
11972
11973 Several types of actions are supported :
11974 - accept : the request is accepted
11975 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11976 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11977 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011978 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011979 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011980 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011981 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011982 - silent-drop
11983
11984 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11985 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11986 sections for a complete description.
11987
11988 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11989 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11990 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11991
11992 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11993 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11994 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11995 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11996 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11997
11998 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11999 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12000
12001 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12002 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12003 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12004
12005 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12006 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12007 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12008
12009 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12010 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12011 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12012
12013 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12014 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12015 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12016
12017 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12018
12019 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12020
12021
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012022tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12023 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12025 no | no | yes | yes
12026 Arguments :
12027 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12028 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12029 as explained at the top of this document.
12030
12031 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12032
12033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012034timeout check <timeout>
12035 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12036 established.
12037
12038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12039 yes | no | yes | yes
12040 Arguments:
12041 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12043 as explained at the top of this document.
12044
12045 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12046 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012047 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012048 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012049 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12050 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12051 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012052
12053 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12054 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12055
12056 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12057 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012058 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012059
12060 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12061 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12062 forget about it.
12063
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012064 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12065 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012066
12067
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012068timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012069 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12071 yes | yes | yes | no
12072 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012073 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012074 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12075 as explained at the top of this document.
12076
12077 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12078 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12079 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012080 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12081 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12082 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12083 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012084 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12085 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12086 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012087 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012088 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012089 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12090 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012091 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12092 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012093
12094 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12095 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12096 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12097 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012098 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012099 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12100
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012101 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012102
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012103 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012105
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012106timeout client-fin <timeout>
12107 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12109 yes | yes | yes | no
12110 Arguments :
12111 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12112 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12113 as explained at the top of this document.
12114
12115 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12116 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12117 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12118 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12119 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12120 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12121 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012122 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12123 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12124 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012125
12126 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12127 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12128 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12129
12130 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12131
12132
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012133timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012134 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12136 yes | no | yes | yes
12137 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012138 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012139 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12140 as explained at the top of this document.
12141
12142 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012143 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012144 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012145 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012146 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12147 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012148
12149 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12150 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12151 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12152 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012153 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012154 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12155
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012156 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012157
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012158
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012159timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12160 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12162 yes | yes | yes | yes
12163 Arguments :
12164 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12165 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12166 as explained at the top of this document.
12167
12168 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12169 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12170 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12171 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12172 once the request has started to present itself.
12173
12174 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12175 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12176 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12177 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12178 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12179
12180 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12181 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12182 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12183 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12184
12185 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12186 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012187 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012188 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12189 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012190 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012191
12192 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12193 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12194 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12195 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12196
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012197 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12198 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012199 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12200
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012201 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12202
12203
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012204timeout http-request <timeout>
12205 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012207 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012208 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012209 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12211 as explained at the top of this document.
12212
12213 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12214 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12215 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12216 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12217 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12218 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12219 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012220 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12221 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12222 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12223 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012224 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012225 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12226 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012227
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012228 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12229 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12230 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12231 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12232 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012233 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012234
12235 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12236 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012237 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012238 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12239 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12240
12241 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012242 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12243 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12244 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012245
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012246 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012247 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012248
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012249
12250timeout queue <timeout>
12251 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12253 yes | no | yes | yes
12254 Arguments :
12255 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12256 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12257 as explained at the top of this document.
12258
12259 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12260 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12261 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12262 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12263 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12264
12265 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12266 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12267 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12268 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12269
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012270 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012271
12272
12273timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012274 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12276 yes | no | yes | yes
12277 Arguments :
12278 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12279 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12280 as explained at the top of this document.
12281
12282 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12283 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12284 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12285 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12286 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12287 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12288 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12289
12290 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12291 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12292 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12293 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12294 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012295 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012296 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012297 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12298 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012299 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12300 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012301
12302 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12303 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12304 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12305 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012306 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012307 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12308
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012309 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012310
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012311
12312timeout server-fin <timeout>
12313 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12315 yes | no | yes | yes
12316 Arguments :
12317 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12318 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12319 as explained at the top of this document.
12320
12321 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12322 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12323 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12324 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12325 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12326 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12327 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12328 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12329 situations, it should not be needed.
12330
12331 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12332 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12333 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12334
12335 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12336
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012337
12338timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012339 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12341 yes | yes | yes | yes
12342 Arguments :
12343 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12344 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12345 as explained at the top of this document.
12346
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012347 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12348 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12349 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012350
12351 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12352 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12353 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12354 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012355 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012356
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012357 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012358
12359
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012360timeout tunnel <timeout>
12361 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12363 yes | no | yes | yes
12364 Arguments :
12365 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12366 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12367 as explained at the top of this document.
12368
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012369 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012370 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12371 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12372 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012373 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12374 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012375 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12376 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12377 specified.
12378
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012379 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12380 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12381 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12382 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12383 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12384 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12385 state.
12386
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012387 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12388 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12389 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12390 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012391 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012392
12393 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12394 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12395 forget about it.
12396
12397 Example :
12398 defaults http
12399 option http-server-close
12400 timeout connect 5s
12401 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012402 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012403 timeout server 30s
12404 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12405
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012406 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012407
12408
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012409transparent (deprecated)
12410 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012412 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012413 Arguments : none
12414
12415 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12416 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12417 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12418 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12419 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12420 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12421 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12422 appropriate server.
12423
12424 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12425
12426 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12427 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12428
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012429 See also: "option transparent"
12430
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012431unique-id-format <string>
12432 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12434 yes | yes | yes | no
12435 Arguments :
12436 <string> is a log-format string.
12437
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012438 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12439 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12440 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12441 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012442
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012443 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12444 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12445 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12446 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12447 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12448 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12449 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12450 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012451
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012452 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12453 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012454
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012455 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012456
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012457 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012458
12459 will generate:
12460
12461 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12462
12463 See also: "unique-id-header"
12464
12465unique-id-header <name>
12466 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12468 yes | yes | yes | no
12469 Arguments :
12470 <name> is the name of the header.
12471
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012472 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12473 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012474
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012475 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012476
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012477 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012478 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12479
12480 will generate:
12481
12482 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12483
12484 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012485
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012486use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012487 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12489 no | yes | yes | no
12490 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012491 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12492 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012493
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012494 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12495 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012496
12497 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12498 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12499 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012500 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012501 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012502 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12503 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012504
12505 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12506 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12507 assign the backend.
12508
12509 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12510 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12511 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12512 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12513 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12514 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12515
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012516 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012517 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012518 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12519 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12520 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12521
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012522 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12523 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12524 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12525 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12526 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12527 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12528 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12529 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12530 cannot be forced from the request.
12531
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012532 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012533 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12534 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12535
12536 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12537 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012538
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012539use-fcgi-app <name>
12540 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12542 no | no | yes | yes
12543 Arguments :
12544 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12545
12546 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012547
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012548use-server <server> if <condition>
12549use-server <server> unless <condition>
12550 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12552 no | no | yes | yes
12553 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012554 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12555 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012556
12557 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12558
12559 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12560 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12561 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12562
12563 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12564 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12565 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12566 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12567 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12568 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12569 matches will assign the server.
12570
12571 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12572 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12573 with the next rules until one matches.
12574
12575 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12576 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12577 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12578 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12579
12580 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12581 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12582 stripped.
12583
12584 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12585 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012586 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12587 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12588 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012589
12590 Example :
12591 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12592 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12593 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12594 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012595 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012596 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012597 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012598 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12599 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12600
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012601 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12602 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12603 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12604 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012605 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012606 and we fall back to load balancing.
12607
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012608 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012609
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012610
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126115. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012612--------------------------
12613
12614The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12615depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12616settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12617written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12618described in this section.
12619
12620
126215.1. Bind options
12622-----------------
12623
12624The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12625as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12626no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12627parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12628while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12629provided immediately after the setting name.
12630
12631The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12632
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012633accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12634 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12635 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12636 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12637 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12638 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12639 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12640 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12641 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12642 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012643 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12644 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12645 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012646
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012647accept-proxy
12648 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012649 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12650 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012651 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12652 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12653 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12654 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012655 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012656 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12657 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012658 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12659 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012660
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012661allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012662 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012663 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012664 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012665 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12666 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012667
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012668alpn <protocols>
12669 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12670 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12671 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012672 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012673 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012674 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12675 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12676 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12677 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12678 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12679 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12680 preference, like below :
12681
12682 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012683
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012684backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012685 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012686 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12687
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012688curves <curves>
12689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12690 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12691 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12692 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12693 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12694 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12695
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012696ecdhe <named curve>
12697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012698 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12699 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012700
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012701ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012702 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12703 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12704 client's certificate.
12705
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012706ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12708 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12709 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12710 error is ignored.
12711
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012712ca-sign-file <cafile>
12713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12714 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12715 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12716 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12717 'generate-certificates' for details.
12718
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012719ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12721 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12722 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12723 'generate-certificates' for details.
12724
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012725ca-verify-file <cafile>
12726 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12727 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12728 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12729 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12730 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12731
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012732ciphers <ciphers>
12733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12734 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012735 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012736 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012737 information and recommendations see e.g.
12738 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12739 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12740 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12741
12742ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12743 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12744 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12745 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12746 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012747 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12748 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012749
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012750crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12752 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12753 to verify client's certificate.
12754
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012755crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12757 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12758 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12759 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12760 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012761 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12762 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012763
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012764 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12765 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12766
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012767 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12768 are loaded.
12769
12770 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012771 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12772 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12773 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12774 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12775 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12776 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12777 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012778 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012779
12780 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12781 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12782 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12783 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012784 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12785 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012786
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012787 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012788
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012789 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012790 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012791 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12792 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012793 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12794 clients).
12795
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012796 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12797 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12798 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12799 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12800 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12801 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12802 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12803 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12804 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12805 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12806 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12807 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12808 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12809
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012810 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12811 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12812 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12813 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12814 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12815
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012816 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12817 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12818 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12819 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012820
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012821 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12822 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12823 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012824
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012825crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012827 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012828 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012829 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012830
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012831crt-list <file>
12832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012833 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12834 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012835
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012836 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12837
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012838 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12839 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12840 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12841 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12842 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012843
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012844 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012845 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12846 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12847 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12848 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12849 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012850 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12851 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12852 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012853
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012854 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12855 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12856 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012857
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012858 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12859
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012860 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12861 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12862 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12863 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12864 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12865 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12866 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12867 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012868
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012869 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012870 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012871 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012872 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012873 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012874 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012875
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012876defer-accept
12877 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12878 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12879 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012880 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012881 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12882 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12883 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12884 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12885 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12886 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12887 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12888
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012889expose-fd listeners
12890 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12891 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012892 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12893 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012894 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012895
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012896force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012897 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012898 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012899 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012900 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012901
12902force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012903 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012904 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012905 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012906
12907force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012908 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012909 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012910 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012911
12912force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012913 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012914 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012915 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012916
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012917force-tlsv13
12918 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12919 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012920 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012921
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012922generate-certificates
12923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12924 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12925 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12926 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12927 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12928 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12929 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12930 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12931 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12932 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12933 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12934
12935 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12936 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012937 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012938 certificate is used many times.
12939
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012940gid <gid>
12941 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12942 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12943 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12944 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12945 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12946
12947group <group>
12948 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12949 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12950 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12951 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12952 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12953
12954id <id>
12955 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12956 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12957 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12958 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12959
12960interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012961 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12962 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12963 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12964 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12965 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12966 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012967 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12968 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12969 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12970 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12971 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12972 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012973
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012974level <level>
12975 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12976 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12977 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012978 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012979 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12980 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12981 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012982 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012983 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012984 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012985 all counters).
12986
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012987severity-output <format>
12988 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12989 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12990 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12991 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12992 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12993 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12994 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12995 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12996 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12997 rfc5424 convention.
12998
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012999maxconn <maxconn>
13000 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13001 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13002 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13003 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13004 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13005 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13006 eat all memory.
13007
13008mode <mode>
13009 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13010 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13011 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13012 UNIX sockets.
13013
13014mss <maxseg>
13015 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13016 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13017 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13018 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13019 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13020 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13021 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13022 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13023 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13024 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13025 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13026
13027name <name>
13028 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13029 page.
13030
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013031namespace <name>
13032 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13033 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13034 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13035 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13036
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013037nice <nice>
13038 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13039 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13040 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13041 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13042 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13043 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13044 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13045 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13046 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13047 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13048 one for an RDP socket.
13049
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013050no-ca-names
13051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13052 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013053 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013054
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013055no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013056 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013057 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013058 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013059 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013060 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13061 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013062
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013063no-tls-tickets
13064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13065 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13066 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013067 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13068 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013069 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13070 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13071 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013072
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013073no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013074 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013075 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013076 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013077 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013078 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13079 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013080
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013081no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013083 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013084 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013085 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013086 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13087 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013088
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013089no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013091 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013092 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013093 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013094 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13095 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013096
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013097no-tlsv13
13098 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13099 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13100 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13101 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013102 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13103 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013104
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013105npn <protocols>
13106 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13107 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13108 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013109 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013110 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013111 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13112 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13113 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13114 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13115 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013116
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013117prefer-client-ciphers
13118 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13119 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13120 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013121 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13122 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13123 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013124
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013125process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013126 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013127 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013128 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013129 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13130 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13131 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13132 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013133 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013134 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13135 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13136 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13137 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13138 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013139
13140 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13141
13142 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13143 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13144 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13145 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13146 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13147 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13148 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13149 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013150
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013151proto <name>
13152 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13153 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13154 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13155 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013156 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013157 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013158 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013159 h2" on the bind line.
13160
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013161ssl
13162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013163 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013164 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13165 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013166 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13167 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013168
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013169ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13170 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013171 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13172 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13173 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013174 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13175
13176ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013177 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13178 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13179 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13180 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013181
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013182strict-sni
13183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13184 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13185 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13186 See the "crt" option for more information.
13187
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013188tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013189 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013190 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13191 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013192 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013193 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13194 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13195 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13196 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13197 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13198 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13199 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13200
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013201tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013202 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013203 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13204 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13205 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13206 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13207 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13208 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13209 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013210 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13211 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13212 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013213
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013214tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13215 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013216 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13217 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13218 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13219 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13220 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13221 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13222 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13223 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13224 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13225 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013226 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13227 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13228
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013229transparent
13230 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13231 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13232 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13233 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13234 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13235 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13236 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13237 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13238 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13239 so check for support with your vendor.
13240
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013241v4v6
13242 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13243 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13244 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13245 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013246 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013247
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013248v6only
13249 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13250 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13251 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013252 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13253 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013254
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013255uid <uid>
13256 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13257 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13258 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13259 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13260 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13261
13262user <user>
13263 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13264 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13265 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13266 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13267 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13268
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013269verify [none|optional|required]
13270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13271 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13272 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13273 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13274 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013275 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13276 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13277 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13278 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013279
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200132805.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013281------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013283The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13284which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13285arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13286settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13287after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13288Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13289address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013291 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013292 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013293
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013294Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13295keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013297The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013298
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013299addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013300 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013301 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13302 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13303 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13304 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13305 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013306
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013307agent-check
13308 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013309 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013310 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13311 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13312 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013313
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013314 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013315 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013316 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13317 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13318 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013319
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013320 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13321 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13322 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13323 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13324 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013325
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013326 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013327 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013328
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013329 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13330 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13331 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013332
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013333 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13334 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13335 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013336
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013337 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013338 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13339 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13340 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13341 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013342 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013343 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013344
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013345 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13346 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013347
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013348 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13349 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13350 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13351 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13352 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13353 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13354 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13355 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13356 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013357
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013358 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13359 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013360 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13361 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13362 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013363 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013364
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013365 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013366 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013367
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013368agent-send <string>
13369 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13370 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13371 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13372 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13373 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13374
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013375agent-inter <delay>
13376 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13377 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13378
13379 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13380 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13381 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13382 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13383 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13384 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13385 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13386 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13387 of backends use the same servers.
13388
13389 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13390
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013391agent-addr <addr>
13392 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13393
13394 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13395 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13396 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13397 hostname, it will be resolved.
13398
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013399agent-port <port>
13400 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13401
13402 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13403
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013404allow-0rtt
13405 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013406 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13407 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013408
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013409alpn <protocols>
13410 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13411 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13412 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013413 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013414 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13415 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13416 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13417 now obsolete NPN extension.
13418 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13419 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13420
13421 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013423backup
13424 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13425 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13426 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13427 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013428 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13429 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013430
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013431ca-file <cafile>
13432 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13433 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13434 server's certificate.
13435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013436check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013437 This option enables health checks on a server:
13438 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13439 considered available.
13440 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13441 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13442 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13443 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13444 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13445 set.
13446 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13447 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13448 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13449 exchanges succeed.
13450
13451 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13452 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13453 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13454 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13455 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013456 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013457 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13458
13459 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13460 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13461
13462 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13463 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13464
13465 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13466 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13467 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13468 available.
13469
13470 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13471 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13472 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13473
13474 Example:
13475 # simple tcp check
13476 backend foo
13477 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13478 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13479 backend foo
13480 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13481 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13482 backend foo
13483 option tcp-check
13484 tcp-check connect
13485 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013486
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013487check-send-proxy
13488 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13489 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13490 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13491 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13492 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13493 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13494 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13495
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013496check-alpn <protocols>
13497 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13498 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13499 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13500
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013501check-proto <name>
13502 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13503 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13504 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13505 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013506 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013507 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13508 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13509
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013510check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013511 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013512 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13513 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013514
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013515check-ssl
13516 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13517 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13518 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13519 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013520 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013521 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13522 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013523 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013524 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13525 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013526
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013527check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013528 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013529 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13530 for normal traffic.
13531
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013532ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13534 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13535 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013536 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13537 information and recommendations see e.g.
13538 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13539 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13540 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013541
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013542ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13544 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13545 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13546 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013547 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13548 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13549 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013551cookie <value>
13552 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13553 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13554 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13555 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13556 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13557 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13558 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13559
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013560crl-file <crlfile>
13561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13562 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13563 to verify server's certificate.
13564
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013565crt <cert>
13566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13567 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13568 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13569 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13570 certificate request.
13571
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013572disabled
13573 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13574 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13575 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13576 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13577 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013578 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013579
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013580enabled
13581 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13582 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13583 default value.
13584 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13585 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013587error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013588 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13589 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13590 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013592 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013594fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013595 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13596 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13597 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13598
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013599force-sslv3
13600 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13601 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013602 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013603 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013604
13605force-tlsv10
13606 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013607 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013608 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013609
13610force-tlsv11
13611 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013612 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013613 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013614
13615force-tlsv12
13616 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013617 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013618 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013619
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013620force-tlsv13
13621 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13622 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013623 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013625id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013626 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13627 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13628 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013629
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013630init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13631 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13632 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013633 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013634 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13635 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13636 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13637 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13638 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13639 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13640 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13641 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13642 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013643 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013644 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13645 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13646 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13647 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13648 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13649 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013650 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013651
13652 Example:
13653 defaults
13654 # never fail on address resolution
13655 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013657inter <delay>
13658fastinter <delay>
13659downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013660 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13661 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13662 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13663 between checks depending on the server state :
13664
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013665 Server state | Interval used
13666 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13667 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13668 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13669 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13670 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13671 or yet unchecked. |
13672 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13673 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13674 | "inter" otherwise.
13675 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013677 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13678 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13679 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13680 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013681 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13682 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13683 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13684 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13685 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013686
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013687log-proto <logproto>
13688 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13689 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13690 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13691 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013693maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013694 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13695 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013696 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13697 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013698 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13699 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13700 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13701 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13702
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013703 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13704 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13705 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13706 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13707 than 50 concurrent requests.
13708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013709maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013710 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13711 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13712 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13713 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013714 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13715 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13716 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13717 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13718 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13719 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13720 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013721
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013722max-reuse <count>
13723 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13724 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13725 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13726 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13727 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13728 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13729 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13730 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013732minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013733 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13734 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13735 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13736 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13737 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13738 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013739 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013740 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013741
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013742namespace <name>
13743 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13744 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13745 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13746 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13747
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013748no-agent-check
13749 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13750 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13751 default value.
13752 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13753 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13754
13755no-backup
13756 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13757 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13758 default value.
13759 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13760 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13761
13762no-check
13763 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13764 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13765 default value.
13766 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13767 "default-server" "check" setting.
13768
13769no-check-ssl
13770 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13771 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13772 default value.
13773 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13774 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13775
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013776no-send-proxy
13777 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13778 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13779 default value.
13780 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13781 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13782
13783no-send-proxy-v2
13784 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13785 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13786 default value.
13787 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13788 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13789
13790no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13791 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13792 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13793 default value.
13794 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13795 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13796
13797no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13798 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13799 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13800 default value.
13801 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13802 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13803
13804no-ssl
13805 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13806 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13807 default value.
13808 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13809 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13810
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013811 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13812 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13813 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13814
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013815no-ssl-reuse
13816 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13817 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13818 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13819 and for paranoid users.
13820
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013821no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013822 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13823 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013824 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013825
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013826 Supported in default-server: No
13827
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013828no-tls-tickets
13829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13830 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13831 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013832 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13833 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013834 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13835 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13836 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013837 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013838
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013839no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013840 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013841 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13842 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013843 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13844 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013845 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013846
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013847 Supported in default-server: No
13848
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013849no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013850 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013851 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13852 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013853 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13854 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013855 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013856
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013857 Supported in default-server: No
13858
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013859no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013860 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013861 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13862 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013863 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13864 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013865 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013866
13867 Supported in default-server: No
13868
13869no-tlsv13
13870 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13871 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13872 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13873 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13874 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013875 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013876
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013877 Supported in default-server: No
13878
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013879no-verifyhost
13880 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13881 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13882 default value.
13883 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13884 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013885
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013886no-tfo
13887 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13888 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13889 default value.
13890 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13891 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13892
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013893non-stick
13894 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13895 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13896 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13897
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013898npn <protocols>
13899 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13900 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13901 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013902 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013903 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13904 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13905 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013907observe <mode>
13908 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13909 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13910 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13911 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13912 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13913 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013914 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013915
13916 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013918on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013919 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13920 Currently, four modes are available:
13921 - fastinter: force fastinter
13922 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13923 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13924 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13925 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13926
13927 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13928
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013929on-marked-down <action>
13930 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13931 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013932 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13933 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13934 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13935 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13936 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13937 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13938 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13939 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013940
13941 Actions are disabled by default
13942
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013943on-marked-up <action>
13944 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13945 Currently one action is available:
13946 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13947 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13948 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13949 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013950 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13951 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013952 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13953 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13954
13955 Actions are disabled by default
13956
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013957pool-low-conn <max>
13958 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13959 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13960 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13961 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13962 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13963 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13964 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13965 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13966 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13967 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13968 applying to "http-reuse".
13969
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013970pool-max-conn <max>
13971 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13972 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13973 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13974 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13975 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13976 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13977
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013978pool-purge-delay <delay>
13979 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013980 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013981 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013983port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013984 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13985 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13986 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13987 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13988 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13989 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13990
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013991proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013992 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13993 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13994 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13995 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013996 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013997 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013999redir <prefix>
14000 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14001 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14002 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14003 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14004 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14005 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14006 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14007 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014008 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014009 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014010 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14011 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14012 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14013 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14014
14015 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014017rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014018 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14019 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14020 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14021
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014022resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14023 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14024 server.
14025
14026 Available options:
14027
14028 * allow-dup-ip
14029 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14030 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14031 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14032 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14033 For such case, simply enable this option.
14034 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14035
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014036 * ignore-weight
14037 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14038 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14039 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14040
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014041 * prevent-dup-ip
14042 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14043 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14044 same fqdn.
14045 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14046
14047 Example:
14048 backend b_myapp
14049 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14050 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14051 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14052
14053 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14054 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14055 it
14056 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14057 different address
14058
14059 Default value: not set
14060
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014061resolve-prefer <family>
14062 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14063 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14064 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14065 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14066
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014067 Default value: ipv6
14068
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014069 Example:
14070
14071 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014072
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014073resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014074 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014075 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014076 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014077 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14078 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014079 configured network, another address is selected.
14080
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014081 Example:
14082
14083 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014084
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014085resolvers <id>
14086 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14087 hostname.
14088
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014089 Example:
14090
14091 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014092
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014093 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014094
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014095send-proxy
14096 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14097 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14098 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14099 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014100 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14101 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14102 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14103 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14104 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14105 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14106 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14107 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14108 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14109 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014110 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14111 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014112
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014113send-proxy-v2
14114 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14115 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14116 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14117 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014118 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14119 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14120 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14121 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014122
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014123proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014124 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14125 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14126
14127 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14128 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14129 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14130 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14131 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14132 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14133 connection is supported).
14134 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14135 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14136 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14137 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14138 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14139 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14140 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014141
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014142send-proxy-v2-ssl
14143 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14144 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14145 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14146 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14147 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14148 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14149 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014150 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14151 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014152
14153send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14154 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14155 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14156 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14157 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14158 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14159 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14160 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14161 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014162 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14163 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014164
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014165slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014166 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14167 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14168 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14169 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14170 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14171 parameters :
14172
14173 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14174 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14175
14176 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14177 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14178 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14179 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14180
14181 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14182 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14183 seen as failed.
14184
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014185sni <expression>
14186 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14187 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14188 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14189 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014190 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14191 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014192 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014193 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14194 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014195
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014196source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014197source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014198source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014199 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14200 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14201 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14202 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14203
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014204 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14205 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14206 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14207 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14208 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14209 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14210 server.
14211
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014212 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14213 specifying the source address without port(s).
14214
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014215ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014216 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14217 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14218 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14219 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14220 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14221 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014222 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14223 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014224
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014225ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14226 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14227 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14228 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14229
14230ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14231 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14232 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14233 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14234
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014235ssl-reuse
14236 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14237 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14238 default value.
14239 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14240 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14241
14242stick
14243 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14244 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14245 default value.
14246 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14247 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014248
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014249socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014250 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014251 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14252 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14253
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014254tcp-ut <delay>
14255 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14256 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14257 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014258 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014259 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14260 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14261 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14262 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14263 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14264 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14265 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14266 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14267 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14268
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014269tfo
14270 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14271 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14272 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14273 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14274 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014275 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014277track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014278 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14279 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14280 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14281 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014282 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14283
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014284tls-tickets
14285 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14286 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14287 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014288 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14289 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14290 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014291 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014292 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014293
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014294verify [none|required]
14295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014296 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014297 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14298 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014299 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014300 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14301 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14302 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14303 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14304 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14305 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14306 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14307 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014308
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014309verifyhost <hostname>
14310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014311 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14312 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14313 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14314 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14315 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14316 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14317 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14318 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014320weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014321 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14322 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14323 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014324 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14325 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14326 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14327 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14328 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14329 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014330
14331
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143325.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14333-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014334
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014335HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14336using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14337configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014338This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14339can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14340workload.
14341This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14342resolution at run time.
14343Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14344carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14345
14346
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143475.3.1. Global overview
14348----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014349
14350As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14351different steps of the process life:
14352
14353 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14354 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14355 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14356
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014357 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14358 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014359
14360A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14361 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14362 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14363 resolution to know this new IP.
14364
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014365When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014366HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014367SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14368from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14369will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14370will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014371
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014372A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014373 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014374 first valid response.
14375
14376 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14377 servers return an error.
14378
14379
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143805.3.2. The resolvers section
14381----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014382
14383This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014384HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14385contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014386
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014387When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14388uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14389is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14390answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14391
14392When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014393used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014394
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014395 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14396 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14397 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014398
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014399 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14400 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014401
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014402 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14403 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14404 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014405
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014406For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14407following scenarios are possible:
14408
14409 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14410 ignored
14411
14412 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14413 applied
14414
14415 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14416 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14417
14418 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14419 retries the query with a new type
14420
14421 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14422 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014423
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014424As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14425a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014426<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014427
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014428
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014429resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014430 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014431
14432A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14433
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014434accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014435 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014436 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014437 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14438 by RFC 6891)
14439
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014440 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14441
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014442nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14443 DNS server description:
14444 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14445 <ip> : IP address of the server
14446 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14447
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014448parse-resolv-conf
14449 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14450 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14451 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14452
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014453hold <status> <period>
14454 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14455 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014456 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014457 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014458 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14459 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14460 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14461
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014462 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014463
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014464resolve_retries <nb>
14465 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14466 giving up.
14467 Default value: 3
14468
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014469 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14470 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14471 type.
14472
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014473timeout <event> <time>
14474 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14475 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14476 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014477 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14478 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014479 Default value: 1s
14480 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014481 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014482 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014483 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14484 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14485
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014486 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014487
14488 resolvers mydns
14489 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14490 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014491 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014492 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014493 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014494 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014495 hold other 30s
14496 hold refused 30s
14497 hold nx 30s
14498 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014499 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014500 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014501
14502
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145036. Cache
14504---------
14505
14506HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14507(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14508RAM.
14509
14510The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14511this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14512
14513If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14514independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14515when we try to allocate a new one.
14516
14517The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14518
14519It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14520"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14521for more details.
14522
14523When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14524replaced by "<CACHE>".
14525
14526
145276.1. Limitation
14528----------------
14529
14530The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14531
14532- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014533- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14534 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14535 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014536- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14537- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014538- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14539 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14540 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014541
14542- If the request is not a GET
14543- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14544- If the request contains an Authorization header
14545
14546
145476.2. Setup
14548-----------
14549
14550To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14551the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14552
14553
145546.2.1. Cache section
14555---------------------
14556
14557cache <name>
14558 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14559 size of cache is mandatory.
14560
14561total-max-size <megabytes>
14562 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14563 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14564
14565max-object-size <bytes>
14566 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14567 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14568 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14569
14570max-age <seconds>
14571 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14572 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14573 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14574 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14575 default.
14576
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014577process-vary <0 or 1>
14578 Disable or enable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
14579 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14580 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14581 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
14582 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is 0 (disabled).
14583
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014584
145856.2.2. Proxy section
14586---------------------
14587
14588http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14589 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14590 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14591 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14592 after this one.
14593
14594http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14595 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14596 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14597 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14598 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14599
14600
14601Example:
14602
14603 backend bck1
14604 mode http
14605
14606 http-request cache-use foobar
14607 http-response cache-store foobar
14608 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14609
14610 cache foobar
14611 total-max-size 4
14612 max-age 240
14613
14614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146157. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14616----------------------------------
14617
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014618HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014619client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14620The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14621these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14622but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14623data called patterns.
14624
14625
146267.1. ACL basics
14627---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014628
14629The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14630content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14631from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14632simple :
14633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014634 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014635 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014636 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14637 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014639The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14640adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014641
14642In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014644 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014645
14646This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14647Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14648and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014649an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14650conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14651as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14652are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014653
14654ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14655'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14656which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14657
14658There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14659performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014661The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14662specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14663this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014664methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14665ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014666
14667Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14668 - boolean
14669 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14670 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14671 - string
14672 - data block
14673
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014674Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14675converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14676would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14677The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14678which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14679
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014680Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14681keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14682fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14683which are summarized in the table below :
14684
14685 +---------------------+-----------------+
14686 | Sample or converter | Default |
14687 | output type | matching method |
14688 +---------------------+-----------------+
14689 | boolean | bool |
14690 +---------------------+-----------------+
14691 | integer | int |
14692 +---------------------+-----------------+
14693 | ip | ip |
14694 +---------------------+-----------------+
14695 | string | str |
14696 +---------------------+-----------------+
14697 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14698 +---------------------+-----------------+
14699
14700Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14701matching method, see below.
14702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014703The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14704 - boolean
14705 - integer or integer range
14706 - IP address / network
14707 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14708 - regular expression
14709 - hex block
14710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014711The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14712
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014713 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14714 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014715 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014716 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014717 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014718 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014719 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014721The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14722read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14723if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14724lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14725will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14726beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14727a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14728lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14729exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14730
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014731The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14732parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14733ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14734a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14735check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14736
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014737The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14738socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14739file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14742loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14743
14744 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14745
14746In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14747the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14748case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14749as well.
14750
14751The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14752sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14753do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14754methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14755is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014756obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14758default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14759that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14760string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14761
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014762The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14763By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14764string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14765resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14766server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014767waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014768flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14769function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14772sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14773be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014774
14775 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14776 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014777 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14778 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14779 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14780 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014781
14782 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14783 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014785
14786 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014788
14789 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014790 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014791
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014792 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014793 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14794
14795 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14796 binary or string samples.
14797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14799 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14802 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14803 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014805 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14806 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14809 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014811 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14812 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14815 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014816 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014818 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14819 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14820 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014821
14822For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14823request, it is possible to do :
14824
14825 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14826
14827In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14828buffer, one would use the following acl :
14829
14830 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14831
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014832On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14833possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14834
14835 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14838criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14839method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14840to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14841criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14842the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014845the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14846For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14849 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14850 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14851 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014852
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014853
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014854The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14855types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14856combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14857brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14858default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014860 +-------------------------------------------------+
14861 | Input sample type |
14862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014863 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14865 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014867 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014869 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014871 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014873 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014875 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014877 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014879 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014881 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014883 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014885 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014887 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14889 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014891
14892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148937.1.1. Matching booleans
14894------------------------
14895
14896In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14897Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14898When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14899that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14900
14901Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14902return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14903"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14904
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149067.1.2. Matching integers
14907------------------------
14908
14909Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14910enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14911to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14912
14913Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14914matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14915lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014916
14917For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14918unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14919representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14920
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014921As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14922two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14923instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14924ranges and operators.
14925
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014926For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014927operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14928Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14929of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014931Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014932
14933 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14934 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14935 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14936 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14937 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14938
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014939For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014940
14941 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14942
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014943This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14944
14945 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14946
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149487.1.3. Matching strings
14949-----------------------
14950
14951String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14952different forms :
14953
14954 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014955 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014956
14957 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014958 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014959
14960 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14961 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14962
14963 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14964 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14965
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014966 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14968 matches.
14969
14970 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14971 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14972 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014973
14974String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14975exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14976characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14977string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14978to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014979before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014980
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014981Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14982(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14983Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14984
14985Example:
14986 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14987 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14988
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149907.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14991---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014992
14993Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14994they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14995possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14996passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14997the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014998the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14999match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015000
15001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150027.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15003-------------------------------------
15004
15005It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15006not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15007a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15008to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15009digits may be used upper or lower case.
15010
15011Example :
15012 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15013 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15014
15015
150167.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15017---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015018
15019IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15020netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15021within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015022host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015023difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15024at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15025does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15026parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015027
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015028The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15029abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15030
15031 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15032 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15033 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15034 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15035 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15036 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15037 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15038 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15039
15040Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15041192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15042
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015043IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15044Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15045trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15046IPv6 patterns.
15047
15048HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15049following situations :
15050 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15051 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15052 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15053 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15054 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15055 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15056 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15057 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15058 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15059 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061
150627.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15063----------------------------------
15064
15065Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15066combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15067
15068 - AND (implicit)
15069 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15070 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15077indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15080"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15081requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15082is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15083
15084 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015085 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15086 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15087 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088
15089To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15090and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15091
15092 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15093 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15094 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15095 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15096
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015097 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015098 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15099 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15100 use_backend www if host_www
15101
15102It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15103expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15104be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15105the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15106
15107 The following rule :
15108
15109 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015110 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015111
15112 Can also be written that way :
15113
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015114 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015115
15116It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15117to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15118simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15119sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15120good use is the following :
15121
15122 With named ACLs :
15123
15124 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15125 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15126 monitor fail if site_dead
15127
15128 With anonymous ACLs :
15129
15130 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15131
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015132See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15133keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134
15135
151367.3. Fetching samples
15137---------------------
15138
15139Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15140against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15141sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15142ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15143of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15144available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15145
15146This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15147Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15148compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15149deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15150
15151The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15152matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15153method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15154indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15155
15156As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15157when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15158mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15159the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15160ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15161
15162Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15163multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15164when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015165incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15166are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015167is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15168all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15169
15170Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15171 - name
15172 - name(arg1)
15173 - name(arg1,arg2)
15174
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015175
151767.3.1. Converters
15177-----------------
15178
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015179Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15180of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15181is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15182was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015183has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015184unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15185
15186These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15187sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15188the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015189support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015190
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015191A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15192support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15193supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15194(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15195bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015198
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001519951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15200 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15201 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15202 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15203 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15204 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15205
15206 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015207 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15208 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015209 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15210 frontend http-in
15211 bind *:8081
15212 default_backend servers
15213 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15214 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15215
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015216add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015217 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015218 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015219 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15220 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015221 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015222 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15223 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15224 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15225 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015226 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015227 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015228
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015229aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15230 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15231 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15232 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15233 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15234 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15235 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15236
15237 Example:
15238 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15239 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15240
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015241and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015242 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015243 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015244 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15245 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015246 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015247 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15248 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15249 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15250 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015251 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015252 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015253
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015254b64dec
15255 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15256 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15257
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015258base64
15259 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015260 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015261 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15262
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015263bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015264 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015265 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015266 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015267 presence of a flag).
15268
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015269bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15270 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15271 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015272 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015273
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015274concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15275 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15276 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15277 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15278 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15279 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15280 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15281 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15282 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15283 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15284 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015285 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015286 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015287 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15288 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015289
15290 Example:
15291 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15292 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15293 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015294 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015295 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15296
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015297cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015298 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15299 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015300
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015301crc32([<avalanche>])
15302 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15303 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15304 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15305 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15306 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15307 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15308 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15309 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15310 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15311 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015312 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15313
15314crc32c([<avalanche>])
15315 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15316 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15317 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15318 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15319 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15320 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15321 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15322 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015323
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015324cut_crlf
15325 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15326 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15327 updated.
15328
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015329da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015330 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15331 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15332 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15333 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015334 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015335 configuration language.
15336
15337 Example:
15338 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015339 bind *:8881
15340 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015341 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015342
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015343debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15344 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15345 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15346 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15347 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15348 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15349 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15350 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15351 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15352 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15353 printable sample types.
15354
15355 Example:
15356 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015357
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015358digest(<algorithm>)
15359 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15360 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15361
15362 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15363 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15364
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015365div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015366 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15367 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015368 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015369 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15370 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015371 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015372 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15373 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15374 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15375 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015377 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015378
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015379djb2([<avalanche>])
15380 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15381 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15382 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15383 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15384 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15385 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15386 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015387 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15388 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015389
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015390even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015391 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015392 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15393
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015394field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15395 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15396 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15397 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15398 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15399 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15400 fields.
15401
15402 Example :
15403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15404 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15405 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15406 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15407 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015408
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015409fix_is_valid
15410 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15411 Information eXchange):
15412
15413 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15414 numeric
15415 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valide FIX version
15416 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15417 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15418 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15419 checksum
15420
15421 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15422 the server can be parsed.
15423
15424 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15425 message, false if not.
15426
15427 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15428
15429 Example:
15430 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15431 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15432
15433fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15434 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15435 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15436 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15437 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15438 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15439 added.
15440
15441 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15442 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15443 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15444 fix_is_valid converter.
15445
15446 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15447
15448 Example:
15449 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15450 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15451 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15452 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15453 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15454
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015455hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015456 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015457 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015458 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015459 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015460
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015461hex2i
15462 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015463 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015464
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015465htonl
15466 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15467 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15468 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15469 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15470
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015471hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15472 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15473 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15474 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15475 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15476
15477 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15478 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15479
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015480http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015481 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15482 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015483 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15484 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15485 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15486 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15487 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15488 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15489 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15490 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015492iif(<true>,<false>)
15493 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15494 string otherwise.
15495
15496 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015497 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015498
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015499in_table(<table>)
15500 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15501 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15502 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015503 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015504 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15505
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015506ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15507 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015508 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015509 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15510 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15511 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15512 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15513 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015514
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015515json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015516 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015517 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015518 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015519 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15520 of errors:
15521 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15522 bytes, ...)
15523 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15524 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15525
15526 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15527 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15528 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15529 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15530 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15531 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015532 - "ascii" : never fails;
15533 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15534 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015535 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015536 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015537 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15538 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15539
15540 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015541 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015542
15543 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015544 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015545 capture request header user-agent len 150
15546 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015547
15548 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15549 GET / HTTP/1.0
15550 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15551
15552 Output log:
15553 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15554
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015555language(<value>[,<default>])
15556 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15557 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15558 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15559 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15560 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15561 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15562 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15563 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15564 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015565 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015566 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15567 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015568
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015569 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015570
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015571 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15572 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015573
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015574 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15575 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15576 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15577 use_backend spanish if es
15578 use_backend french if fr
15579 use_backend english if en
15580 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015581
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015582length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015583 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15584 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15585 type. The result is of type integer.
15586
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015587lower
15588 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15589 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15590 type. The result is of type string.
15591
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015592ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15593 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15594 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15595 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15596 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15597 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15598 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15599
15600 Example :
15601
15602 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015603 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015604 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15605
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015606ltrim(<chars>)
15607 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15608 representation of the input sample.
15609
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015610map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15611map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15612map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15613 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15614 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15615 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15616 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15617 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15618 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15619 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15620 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015621
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015622 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15623 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15624 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015625
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015626 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015627 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015628
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015629 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15630 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15631 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15632 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015633 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15634 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015635 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15636 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15637 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15638 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15639 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15640 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15641 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15642 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015643 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15644 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15645 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015646 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15647 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15648 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15649 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15650 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015651
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015652 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15653 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15654 the corresponding match text.
15655
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015656 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15657 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15658 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15659 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15660 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015662 Example :
15663
15664 # this is a comment and is ignored
15665 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15666 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15667 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15668 | | | `---------- value
15669 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15670 | `---------------------------- key
15671 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15672
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015673mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015674 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15675 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015676 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015677 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015678 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015679 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15680 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15681 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15682 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015683 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015684 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015685
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015686mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15687 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15688 <packettype>.
15689 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15690 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15691 from.
15692 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15693 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15694 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15695
15696 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15697 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15698 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15699 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15700
15701 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15702 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15703 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15704 packets only):
15705 17: Session Expiry Interval
15706 33: Receive Maximum
15707 39: Maximum Packet Size
15708 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15709 25: Request Response Information
15710 23: Request Problem Information
15711 21: Authentication Method
15712 22: Authentication Data
15713 18: Will Delay Interval
15714 1: Payload Format Indicator
15715 2: Message Expiry Interval
15716 3: Content Type
15717 8: Response Topic
15718 9: Correlation Data
15719 Not supported yet:
15720 38: User Property
15721
15722 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15723 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15724 packets only):
15725 17: Session Expiry Interval
15726 33: Receive Maximum
15727 36: Maximum QoS
15728 37: Retain Available
15729 39: Maximum Packet Size
15730 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15731 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15732 31: Reason String
15733 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15734 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15735 42: Shared Subscription Available
15736 19: Server Keep Alive
15737 26: Response Information
15738 28: Server Reference
15739 21: Authentication Method
15740 22: Authentication Data
15741 Not supported yet:
15742 38: User Property
15743
15744 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15745 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15746 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15747 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15748
15749 Example:
15750
15751 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15752 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15753 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15754 if data_in_buffer
15755 # do the same as above
15756 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15757 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15758 if data_in_buffer
15759
15760mqtt_is_valid
15761 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15762
15763 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15764 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15765 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15766 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15767
15768 Example:
15769
15770 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15771 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15772
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015773mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015774 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015775 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15776 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015777 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015778 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015779 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015780 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15781 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15782 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15783 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015784 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015785 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015786
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015787nbsrv
15788 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15789 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15790 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15791 map lookup.
15792
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015793neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015794 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15795 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15796 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15797 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015798
15799not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015800 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015801 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015802 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015803 absence of a flag).
15804
15805odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015806 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015807 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15808
15809or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015810 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015811 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015812 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15813 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015814 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015815 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15816 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15817 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15818 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015819 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015820 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015821
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015822protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15823 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15824 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15825 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15826 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15827 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15828 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15829 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15830 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15831 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15832 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15833 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15834
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015835regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015836 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15837 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15838 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15839 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15840 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15841 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15842 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15843 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15844 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015845 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15846 of characters with other ones.
15847
15848 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15849 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15850 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15851 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15852 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15853 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015854
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015855 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015856
15857 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15858 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15859 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015860 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015861
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015862 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15863 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15864
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015865 # capture groups and backreferences
15866 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015867 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015868 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15869
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015870capture-req(<id>)
15871 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15872 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15873
15874 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015875 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15876 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015877
15878capture-res(<id>)
15879 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15880 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15881
15882 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015883 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15884 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015885
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015886rtrim(<chars>)
15887 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15888 of the input sample.
15889
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015890sdbm([<avalanche>])
15891 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15892 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15893 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15894 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15895 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15896 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15897 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015898 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15899 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015900
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015901secure_memcmp(<var>)
15902 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15903 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15904 match.
15905
15906 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15907 performed in constant time.
15908
15909 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15910 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15911
15912 Example :
15913
15914 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15915 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15916 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15917 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15918
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015919set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015920 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15921 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15922 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015923 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015924 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15925 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015926 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015927 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15928 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015929 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015930 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015931
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015932sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015933 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015934 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15935
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015936sha2([<bits>])
15937 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15938 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15939
15940 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15941 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15942
15943 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15944 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15945
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015946srv_queue
15947 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15948 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15949 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15950 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15951 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15952
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015953strcmp(<var>)
15954 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15955 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15956 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15957 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15958 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15959 shorter).
15960
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015961 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15962 strings in constant time.
15963
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015964 Example :
15965
15966 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15967 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15968 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15969
15970
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015971sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015972 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15973 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015974 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015975 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15976 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015977 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015978 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15979 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015980 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015981 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15982 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015983 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015984 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015985
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015986table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15987 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15988 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15989 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15990 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15991 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15992 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15993
15994
15995table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15996 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15997 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15998 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15999 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16000 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16001 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16002
16003table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016007 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16008 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16009
16010table_conn_cur(<table>)
16011 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16012 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16013 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16014 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16015 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16016
16017table_conn_rate(<table>)
16018 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16019 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16020 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16021 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16022 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16023
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016024table_gpt0(<table>)
16025 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16026 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16027 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16028 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16029 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16030
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016031table_gpc0(<table>)
16032 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16033 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16034 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16035 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16036 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16037
16038table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16039 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16040 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16041 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16042 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16043 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16044 sample fetch keyword.
16045
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016046table_gpc1(<table>)
16047 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16048 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16049 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16050 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16051 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16052
16053table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16054 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16055 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16056 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16057 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16058 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16059 sample fetch keyword.
16060
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016061table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16062 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16063 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016064 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016065 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16066 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16067
16068table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16069 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16070 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16071 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16072 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16073 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16074 keyword.
16075
16076table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016080 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16081 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16082
16083table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16086 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16087 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16088 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16089 keyword.
16090
16091table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016095 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16096 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16097 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16098 keyword.
16099
16100table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016103 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016104 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16105 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16106 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16107 keyword.
16108
16109table_server_id(<table>)
16110 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16111 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16112 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16113 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16114 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16115 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16116
16117table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16118 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16119 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016120 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016121 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16122 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16123 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16124 keyword.
16125
16126table_sess_rate(<table>)
16127 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16128 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16129 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16130 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16131 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16132 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16133 keyword.
16134
16135table_trackers(<table>)
16136 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16137 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16138 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16139 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16140 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16141 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16142 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16143 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16144 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16145 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16146
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016147upper
16148 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16149 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16150 type. The result is of type string.
16151
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016152url_dec([<in_form>])
16153 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16154 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16155 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16156 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16157 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16158 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016159
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016160ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016161 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016162 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16163 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16164 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016165 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16166 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16167 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16168 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016169 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016170 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16171 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016172
16173 Example:
16174 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16175 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16176
16177 message Point {
16178 int32 latitude = 1;
16179 int32 longitude = 2;
16180 }
16181
16182 message PPoint {
16183 Point point = 59;
16184 }
16185
16186 message Rectangle {
16187 // One corner of the rectangle.
16188 PPoint lo = 48;
16189 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16190 PPoint hi = 49;
16191 }
16192
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016193 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16194 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16195 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016196
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016197 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16198 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016199 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016200 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16201
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016202 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016203
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016204 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016205
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016206 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16207 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16208 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016209
16210 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16211 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16212 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16213
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016214 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16215 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16216 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016217
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016218
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016219unset-var(<var name>)
16220 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16221 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16222 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16223 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16224 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16225 response),
16226 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16227 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16228 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16229 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16230
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016231utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16232 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16233 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16234 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16235 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16236 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16237 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16238
16239 Example :
16240
16241 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016242 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016243 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16244
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016245word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16246 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16247 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16248 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016249 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016250 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16251 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16252
16253 Example :
16254 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16255 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16256 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16257 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16258 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016259 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016260
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016261wt6([<avalanche>])
16262 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16263 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16264 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16265 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16266 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16267 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16268 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016269 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16270 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016271
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016272xor(<value>)
16273 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016274 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016275 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016276 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016277 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016278 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16279 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016280 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016281 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16282 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016283 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016284 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016285
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016286xxh32([<seed>])
16287 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16288 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16289 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16290 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16291 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16292 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16293 as cryptographically secure.
16294
16295xxh64([<seed>])
16296 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16297 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16298 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16299 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16300 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16301 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16302 as cryptographically secure.
16303
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016304
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163057.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306--------------------------------------------
16307
16308A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16309not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16310"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16311The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16312
16313always_false : boolean
16314 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16315 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16316
16317always_true : boolean
16318 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16319 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16320
16321avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016322 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16324 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16325 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16326 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16327 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16328 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16329 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16330 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16331 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16332 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16333 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16334 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16335 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016337be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016338 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16339 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16340 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16341 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016342 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16343
16344be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16345 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16346 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16347 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16348 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16349 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016350 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16351 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016352
16353 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16354 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16355 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016357be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16358 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16359 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16360 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016361 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016362 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16363 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016364
16365 Example :
16366 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16367 backend dynamic
16368 mode http
16369 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16370 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016371
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016372bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016373 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16374 of the string.
16375
16376bool(<bool>) : bool
16377 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16378 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016382 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016383 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16384 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016385
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016386 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016387 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016388 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16389
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016390 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16391 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016392
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016393 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016394 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016396 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016397 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016398 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016399 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016400
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016401 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16402 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016403 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016404 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016405
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016406cpu_calls : integer
16407 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16408 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16409 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16410 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16411 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16412 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16413
16414cpu_ns_avg : integer
16415 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16416 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16417 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16418 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16419 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16420 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16421 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16422 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16423 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16424 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16425 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16426
16427cpu_ns_tot : integer
16428 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16429 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16430 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16431 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16432 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16433 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16434 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16435 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16436 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16437 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16438 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16439 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16440 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16441
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016442date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016443 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016444
16445 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16446 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16447 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016448 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16449
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016450 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16451 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16452 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16453 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16454 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16455
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016456 Example :
16457
16458 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16459 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016460
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016461 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16462 # millisecond granularity
16463 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16464
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016465date_us : integer
16466 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16467 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16468 from the same timeval structure.
16469
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016470distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16471 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16472 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16473 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16474 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16475 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16476 list of supported tokens.
16477
16478distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16479 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16480 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16481 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16482 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16483 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16484 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16485 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16486 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16487 supported tokens.
16488
16489 Example :
16490 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16491 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16492 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16493 # send large files to the big farm
16494 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16495
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016496env(<name>) : string
16497 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16498 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16499 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16500 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16501 certain way.
16502
16503 Examples :
16504 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16505 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16506
16507 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16508 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016510fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16511 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016512 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16513 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016514 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16515 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016516 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016517 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16518 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016519
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016520fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16521 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16522 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16523 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016525fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16526 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16527 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16528 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16529 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16530 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16531 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16532 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16533 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016534
16535 Example :
16536 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16537 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16538 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16539 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16540 frontend mail
16541 bind :25
16542 mode tcp
16543 maxconn 100
16544 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16545 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16546 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16547 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016548
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016549hostname : string
16550 Returns the system hostname.
16551
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016552int(<integer>) : signed integer
16553 Returns a signed integer.
16554
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016555ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16556 Returns an ipv4.
16557
16558ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16559 Returns an ipv6.
16560
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016561lat_ns_avg : integer
16562 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16563 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16564 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16565 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16566 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16567 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16568 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16569 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16570 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016571 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16572 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16573 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16574 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16575 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16576 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016577
16578lat_ns_tot : integer
16579 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16580 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16581 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16582 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16583 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16584 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16585 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16586 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16587 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016588 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16589 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16590 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16591 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16592 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016593 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16594 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16595 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16596 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16597 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16598 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16599
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016600meth(<method>) : method
16601 Returns a method.
16602
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016603nbproc : integer
16604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16605 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16606 and debugging purposes.
16607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016608nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16609 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16610 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16611 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016612 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16613 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16614 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016615
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016616prio_class : integer
16617 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16618 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16619 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16620
16621prio_offset : integer
16622 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16623 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16624 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16625 set-priority-offset".
16626
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016627proc : integer
16628 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16629 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16630 debugging purposes.
16631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016632queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016633 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16634 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16635 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016636 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16637 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16638 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16639 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16640 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16641
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016642rand([<range>]) : integer
16643 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16644 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16645 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16646 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16647 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16648
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016649uuid([<version>]) : string
16650 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16651 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16652 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016654srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16655 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16656 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16657 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16658 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16659 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016660 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16661 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16662
16663srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16664 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16665 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16666 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16667 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16668 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16669 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16670 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16671
16672 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16673 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016674
16675srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16676 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16677 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16678 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016679 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016680 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16681 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16682 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16683
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016684srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16685 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16686 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16687 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16688 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16689 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16690 fetch methods.
16691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016692srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16693 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16694 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016695 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016696 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16697 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016698 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016699 overloading servers).
16700
16701 Example :
16702 # Redirect to a separate back
16703 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16704 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16705 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16706
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016707srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16708 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16709 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16710 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16711
16712srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16713 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16714 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16715 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16716
16717srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16718 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16719 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16720 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16721
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016722stopping : boolean
16723 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16724 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16725 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16726
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016727str(<string>) : string
16728 Returns a string.
16729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16731 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16732 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16733
16734table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16735 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16736 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16737 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16738
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016739thread : integer
16740 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16741 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16742 and debugging purposes.
16743
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016744var(<var-name>) : undefined
16745 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016746 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16747 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016748 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016749 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16750 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016751 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016752 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16753 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016754 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016755 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016756
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167577.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016758----------------------------------
16759
16760The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16761closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16762methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16763sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16764TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016765the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16766counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016767"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16768used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16769can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16770Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16771table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16772tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16773currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016774
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016775bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016776 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16777 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16778 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016780be_id : integer
16781 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016782 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16783 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016784
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016785be_name : string
16786 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016787 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16788 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016790dst : ip
16791 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16792 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16793 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16794 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016795 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16796 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16797 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16798 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16799 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16800 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801
16802dst_conn : integer
16803 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16804 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16805 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16806 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16807 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16808 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16809 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16810 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016811
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016812dst_is_local : boolean
16813 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16814 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16815 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16816 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016817 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016818 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16819 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16820 it only once per connection.
16821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016822dst_port : integer
16823 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16824 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16825 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16826 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16827 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16828 an HTTP header.
16829
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016830fc_http_major : integer
16831 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16832 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16833 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16834
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016835fc_pp_authority : string
16836 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16837 if any.
16838
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016839fc_pp_unique_id : string
16840 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16841 if any.
16842
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016843fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16844 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16845 header.
16846
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016847fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16848 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16849 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16850 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16851 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16852 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16853 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16854
16855fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16856 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16857 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16858 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16859 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16860 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16861 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16862
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016863fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016864 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16865 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16866 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16867 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16868
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016869fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016870 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16871 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16872 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16873 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16874
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016875fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016876 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16877 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16878 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16879 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16880
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016881fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016882 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16883 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16884 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16885 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16886
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016887fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016888 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16889 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16890 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16891 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16892
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016893fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016894 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16895 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16896 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16897 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16898
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016899fe_defbe : string
16900 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16901 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016903fe_id : integer
16904 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016905 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016906 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16907
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016908fe_name : string
16909 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16910 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16911 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016913sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016914sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16915sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16916sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016917 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16918 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16919 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16920
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016921sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016922sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16923sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16924sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016925 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16926 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16927 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16928
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016929sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016930sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16931sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16932sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016933 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16934 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016935 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16936 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16937 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016938
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016939 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016940 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16941 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016942 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16943 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16944 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016945 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16946 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16947
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016948sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16949sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16950sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16951sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16952 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16953 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16954 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16955 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16956 when a first ACL was verified.
16957
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016958sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016959sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16960sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16961sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016962 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016963 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16964
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016965sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016966sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16967sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16968sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016969 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16970 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16971 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16972
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016973sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016974sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16975sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16976sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016977 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16978 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16979 See also src_conn_rate.
16980
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016981sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016982sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16983sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16984sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016985 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016986 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016987
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016988sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16989sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16990sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16991sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16992 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16993 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16994
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016995sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16996sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16997sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16998sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16999 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17000 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17001
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017002sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017003sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17004sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17005sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017006 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17007 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17008 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017009 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17010 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17011 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017012
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017013sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17014sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17015sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17016sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17017 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17018 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17019 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17020 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17021 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17022 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17023
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017024sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017025sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17026sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17027sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017028 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017029 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17030 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17031
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017032sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017033sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17034sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17035sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017036 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17037 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17038 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17039 src_http_err_rate.
17040
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017041sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017042sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17043sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17044sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017045 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017046 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17047 src_http_req_cnt.
17048
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017049sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017050sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17051sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17052sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017053 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17054 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17055 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17056 src_http_req_rate.
17057
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017058sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017059sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17060sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17061sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017062 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017063 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17064 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17065 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17066 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017067
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017068 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017069 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17070 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017071 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17072
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017073sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17074sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17075sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17076sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17077 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17078 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17079 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17080 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17081 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17082
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017083sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017084sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17085sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17086sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017087 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17088 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17089 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017090
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017091sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017092sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17093sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17094sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017095 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17096 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17097 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017098
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017099sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017100sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17101sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17102sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017103 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017104 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17105 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17106 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017107 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017108 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17109
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017110sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017111sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17112sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17113sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017114 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17115 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17116 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17117 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17118 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017119 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017120
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017121sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017122sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17123sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17124sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017125 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17126 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17127 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17128
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017129sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017130sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17131sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17132sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017133 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17134 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017135 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017136 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17137 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017138 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17139 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17140 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017142so_id : integer
17143 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17144 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17145 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017146
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017147so_name : string
17148 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17149 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17150 strings instead of integers.
17151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017152src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017153 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017154 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17155 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17156 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017157 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17158 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17159 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017160 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17161 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17162 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17163 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17164 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17165 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17166 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017167
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017168 Example:
17169 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17170 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017172src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17173 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17174 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17175 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017176 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17179 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17180 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017181 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017182 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017184src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17185 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17186 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17187 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17188 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17189 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17190 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017191
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017192 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017193 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17194 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17195 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17196 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017197 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017198 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17199 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17200
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017201src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17202 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17203 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17204 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17205 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17206 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17207 was verified.
17208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017209src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017210 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017211 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017212 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017213 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017215src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017216 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017217 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17218 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017219 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017221src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17222 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17223 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17224 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017225 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017227src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017228 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017229 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017230 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017231 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017232
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017233src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17234 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17235 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17236 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17237 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17238
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017239src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17240 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17241 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17242 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17243 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017245src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017246 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017247 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017248 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17249 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017250 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17251 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17252 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017253
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017254src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17255 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17256 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17257 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17258 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17259 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17260 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17261 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017264 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017265 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017266 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017267 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017268 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017270src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17271 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17272 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17273 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17274 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017275 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017277src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017278 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017279 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17280 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017281 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017283src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17284 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17285 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17286 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017287 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017288 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017290src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17291 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17292 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17293 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017294 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017295 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17296 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017297
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017298 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017299 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017300 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017301 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017302
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017303src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17304 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17305 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17306 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17307 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17308 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17309 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17310
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017311src_is_local : boolean
17312 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17313 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17314 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17315 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017316 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017317 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17318 once per connection.
17319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017320src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017321 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17322 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17323 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17324 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17325 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017327src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017328 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17329 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17330 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17331 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17332 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017334src_port : integer
17335 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17336 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17337 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17338 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017340src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017341 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017342 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17343 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17344 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017345 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017347src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17348 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17349 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17350 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17351 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017352 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017354src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17355 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17356 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17357 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17358 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17359 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17360 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17361 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17362 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017363
17364 Example :
17365 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17366 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17367 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17368 listen ssh
17369 bind :22
17370 mode tcp
17371 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017372 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017374 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017376srv_id : integer
17377 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17378 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017379 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017380
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017381srv_name : string
17382 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17383 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017384 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017385
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173867.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017387----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017389The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17390closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17391when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17392usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017393future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017394
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001739551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17396 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17397 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17398 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17399 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17400 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17401
17402 Example :
17403 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17404 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17405 # the request.
17406 frontend http-in
17407 bind *:8081
17408 default_backend servers
17409 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17410 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17411
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017412ssl_bc : boolean
17413 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17414 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017415 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17416 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017417
17418ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17419 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017420 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17421 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017422
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017423ssl_bc_alpn : string
17424 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17425 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017426 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017427 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17428 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17429 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17430 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17431 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017432 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17433 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017434
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017435ssl_bc_cipher : string
17436 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017437 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17438 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017439
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017440ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17441 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17442 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17443 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017444 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017445
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017446ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17447 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17448 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017449 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17450 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017451
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017452ssl_bc_npn : string
17453 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17454 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017455 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017456 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17457 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17458 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17459 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017460 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17461 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017462
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017463ssl_bc_protocol : string
17464 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017465 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17466 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017467
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017468ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017469 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017470 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017471 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17472 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017473
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017474ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17475 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17476 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17477 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017478 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017479
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017480ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17481 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17482 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017483 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17484 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017485
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017486ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17487 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17488 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17489 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017490 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017491
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017492ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17493 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017494 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17495 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017497ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17498 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17499 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17500 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17501 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17502 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017504ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17505 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17506 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17507 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17508 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017509
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017510ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017511 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17512 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17513 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17514 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17515 does not support resumed sessions.
17516
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017517ssl_c_der : binary
17518 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17519 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17520 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017522ssl_c_err : integer
17523 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17524 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17525 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17526 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17527 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017528
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017529ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017530 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17531 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17532 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17533 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17534 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17535 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17536 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17537 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017538 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17539 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17540 LDAP v3.
17541 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17542 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017544ssl_c_key_alg : string
17545 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17546 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17547 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017549ssl_c_notafter : string
17550 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17551 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17552 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554ssl_c_notbefore : string
17555 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17556 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17557 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017558
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017559ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017560 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17561 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17562 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17563 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17564 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17565 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17566 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17567 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017568 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17569 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17570 LDAP v3.
17571 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17572 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017574ssl_c_serial : binary
17575 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17576 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17577 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017579ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17580 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17581 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17582 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017583 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17584 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17585
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017586 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017587 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017589ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17590 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17591 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17592 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017594ssl_c_used : boolean
17595 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17596 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017598ssl_c_verify : integer
17599 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17600 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17601 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17602 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017604ssl_c_version : integer
17605 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17606 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017607
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017608ssl_f_der : binary
17609 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17610 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17611 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17612
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017613ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017614 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17615 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17616 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17617 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017618 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017619 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17620 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17621 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017622 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17623 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17624 LDAP v3.
17625 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17626 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017628ssl_f_key_alg : string
17629 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17630 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17631 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017633ssl_f_notafter : string
17634 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17635 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17636 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017638ssl_f_notbefore : string
17639 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17640 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17641 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017642
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017643ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17645 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17646 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17647 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17648 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17649 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17650 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17651 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017652 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17653 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17654 LDAP v3.
17655 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17656 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017658ssl_f_serial : binary
17659 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17660 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17661 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017662
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017663ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17664 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17665 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17666 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017668ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17669 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17670 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17671 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017673ssl_f_version : integer
17674 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17675 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17676
17677ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017678 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17679 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17680 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017682 Example :
17683 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17684 listen http-https
17685 bind :80
17686 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17687 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17688
17689ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17690 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17691 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17692
17693ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017694 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017695 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17696 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17697 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17698 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17699 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17700 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17701 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17702 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017704ssl_fc_cipher : string
17705 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17706 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017707
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017708ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17709 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17710 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017711 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017712
17713ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17714 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17715 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017716 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017717
17718ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17719 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17720 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17721 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017722 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017723 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017724
17725ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17726 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17727 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017728 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017729
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017730ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17731 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17732 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17733 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17734
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017735ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17736 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17737 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17738 transport layer.
17739 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17740 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17741 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17742 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17743
17744ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17745 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17746 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17747 transport layer.
17748 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17749 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17750 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17751 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17752
17753ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17754 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17755 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17756 transport layer.
17757 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17758 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17759 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17760 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17761
17762ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17763 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17764 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17765 transport layer.
17766 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17767 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17768 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17769 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17770
17771ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17772 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17773 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17774 transport layer.
17775 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17776 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17777 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17778 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017780ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017781 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17782 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017783 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17784 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17785 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17786 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017787
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017788ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17789 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17790 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17791 wait until the handshake happened.
17792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017793ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17794 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017795 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17796 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017797 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017798 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017799
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017800ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017801 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017802 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17803 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017805ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017806 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017807 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17808 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17809 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17810 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17811 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17812 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17813 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017815ssl_fc_protocol : string
17816 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17817 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017818
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017819ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017820 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017821 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17822 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017823
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017824ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17825 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17826 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17827 transport layer.
17828 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17829 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17830 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17831 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17832
17833ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17834 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17835 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17836 transport layer.
17837 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17838 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17839 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17840 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17841
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017842ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17843 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17844 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17845 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17848 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17849 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17850 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17851 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017852
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017853ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17854 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17855 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17856 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17857 BoringSSL.
17858
17859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017860ssl_fc_sni : string
17861 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17862 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17863 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17864 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17865 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17866
17867 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17868 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17869 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017870 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017871 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017873 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017874 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17875 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017877ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17878 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17879 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017880
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017881ssl_s_der : binary
17882 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17883 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17884 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17885
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017886ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17887 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17888 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17889 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17890 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17891 does not support resumed sessions.
17892
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017893ssl_s_key_alg : string
17894 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17895 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17896 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17897
17898ssl_s_notafter : string
17899 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17900 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17901 transport layer.
17902
17903ssl_s_notbefore : string
17904 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17905 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17906 transport layer.
17907
17908ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17909 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17910 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17911 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17912 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17913 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17914 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017915 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17916 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017917 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17918 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17919 LDAP v3.
17920 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17921 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17922
17923ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17924 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17925 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17926 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17927 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17928 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17929 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017930 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17931 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017932 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17933 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17934 LDAP v3.
17935 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17936 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17937
17938ssl_s_serial : binary
17939 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17940 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17941 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17942
17943ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17944 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17945 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17946 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17947
17948ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17949 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17950 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17951 layer.
17952
17953ssl_s_version : integer
17954 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17955 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017956
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179577.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017958------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017960Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17961sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17962only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17963For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17964be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17965can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17966sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17967for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17968content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017970payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017971 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017972 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17973 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017975payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17976 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017977 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017978 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017979
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017980req.hdrs : string
17981 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17982 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17983 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17984 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17985
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017986req.hdrs_bin : binary
17987 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17988 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17989 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17990 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17991 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17992 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17993
17994 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17995
17996 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17997 str: <int:length><bytes>
17998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017999req.len : integer
18000req_len : integer (deprecated)
18001 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18002 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18003 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18004 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18005 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18006 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18007 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18008 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018010req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18011 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018012 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18013 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18014 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18015 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018017 ACL alternatives :
18018 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18021 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18022 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18023 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18024 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018026 ACL alternatives :
18027 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018029 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018031req.proto_http : boolean
18032req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18033 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18034 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18035 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18036 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18037 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18038 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18039 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018041 Example:
18042 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18043 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18044 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018045 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18048rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18049 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18050 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18051 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18052 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18053 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18054 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18055 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018057 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18058 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18059 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18060 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18061 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18062 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018064 ACL derivatives :
18065 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018067 Example :
18068 listen tse-farm
18069 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18070 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18071 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18072 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18073 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18074 persist rdp-cookie
18075 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18076 # This is only useful makes sense if
18077 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18078 stick-table type string size 204800
18079 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18080 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18081 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18084 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018086req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18087rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18088 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18089 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18090 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18091 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018093 ACL derivatives :
18094 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018095
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018096req.ssl_alpn : string
18097 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18098 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18099 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18100 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18101 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18102 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018103 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018104
18105 Examples :
18106 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18107 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18108 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018109 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018110 default_backend bk_default
18111
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018112req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18113 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18114 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018115 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18116 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18117 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18118 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18119 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018121req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18122req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18123 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18124 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18125 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18126 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18127 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18128 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18129 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018131req.ssl_sni : string
18132req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18133 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18134 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18135 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18136 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18137 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018138 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18139 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18140 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18141 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18142 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18143 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18144 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18145 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18146 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018148 ACL derivatives :
18149 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018151 Examples :
18152 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18153 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18154 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18155 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18156 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018157
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018158req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18159 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18160 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18161 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18162 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18163 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18164 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18165 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18166 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18167 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018169req.ssl_ver : integer
18170req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18171 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18172 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18173 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18174 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18175 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18176 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18177 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018178 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018181 ACL derivatives :
18182 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018183
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018184res.len : integer
18185 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18186 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18187 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18188 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18189 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18190 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18191 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018192 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018194res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18195 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018196 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018197 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018198 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018199 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018201res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18202 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18203 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18204 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018205 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18206 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018208 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018209
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018210res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18211rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18212 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18213 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18214 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18215 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18216 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18217 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18218 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018220wait_end : boolean
18221 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18222 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018223 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018224 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18225 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018226 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018227 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18228 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018230 Examples :
18231 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18232 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18233 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018235 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18236 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18237 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18238 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18239 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18240 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18241 tcp-request content reject
18242
18243
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182447.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245--------------------------------------
18246
18247It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18248This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18249data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18250its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18251HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18252content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18253to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18254more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18255response are indexed.
18256
18257base : string
18258 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18259 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18260 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18261 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18262 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18263 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18264 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18265 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18266
18267 ACL derivatives :
18268 base : exact string match
18269 base_beg : prefix match
18270 base_dir : subdir match
18271 base_dom : domain match
18272 base_end : suffix match
18273 base_len : length match
18274 base_reg : regex match
18275 base_sub : substring match
18276
18277base32 : integer
18278 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18279 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18280 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018281 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18282 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18283 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018284
18285base32+src : binary
18286 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18287 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18288 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18289 per-URL counters.
18290
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018291capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18292 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18293 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18294 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18295
18296capture.req.method : string
18297 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18298 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18299 because it's allocated.
18300
18301capture.req.uri : string
18302 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18303 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18304 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18305 allocated.
18306
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018307capture.req.ver : string
18308 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18309 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18310 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18311
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018312capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18313 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18314 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18315 The first entry is an index of 0.
18316 See also: "capture response header"
18317
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018318capture.res.ver : string
18319 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18320 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18321 persistent flag.
18322
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018323req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018324 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18325 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18326 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018327
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018328req.body_param([<name>) : string
18329 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18330 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18331 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18332 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18333 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18334 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18335 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18336 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18337 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18338 given.
18339
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018340req.body_len : integer
18341 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18342 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018343 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18344 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018345
18346req.body_size : integer
18347 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018348 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18349 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018351req.cook([<name>]) : string
18352cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18353 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18354 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18355 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18356 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18357 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18358 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18359 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18360 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18361
18362 ACL derivatives :
18363 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18364 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18365 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18366 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18367 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18368 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18369 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18370 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18373cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18374 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18375 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018377req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18378cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18379 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18380 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18381 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18382 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018384cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18385 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18386 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18387 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18388 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018389 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018390 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18391 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18392 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18393 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018395hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18396 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18397 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18398 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18399 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018400 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018402req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18403 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18404 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18405 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18406 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18407 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18408 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18409 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18410 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018412req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18413 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18414 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18415 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18416 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18419 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18420 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18421 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18422 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18423 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18424 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18425 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18426 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018427 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018428 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018429 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431 ACL derivatives :
18432 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18433 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18434 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18435 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18436 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18437 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18438 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18439 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18440
18441req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18442hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18443 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18444 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18445 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18446 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18447 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18448 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18449 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18450 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18451 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18452
18453req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18454hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18455 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18456 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18457 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18458 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18459 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018460 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018461 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18462 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18463
18464req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18465hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18466 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18467 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18468 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18469 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18470 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18471 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18472 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18473
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018474
18475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018476http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18477 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18478 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18479 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18480 basic auth is supported.
18481
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018482http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18483 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18484 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18485 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18486 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018487 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18488 basic auth is supported.
18489
18490 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018491 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18492 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18493 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18494 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018495
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018496http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018497 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18498 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18499 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018500
18501http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018502 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18503 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18504 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018505
18506http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018507 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18508 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18509 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018511http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018512 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18513 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018514 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18515 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018517method : integer + string
18518 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18519 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18520 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18521 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18522 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18523 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18524 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018526 ACL derivatives :
18527 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018529 Example :
18530 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18531 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18532 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018534path : string
18535 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18536 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18537 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18538 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18539 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018540 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018541 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018543 ACL derivatives :
18544 path : exact string match
18545 path_beg : prefix match
18546 path_dir : subdir match
18547 path_dom : domain match
18548 path_end : suffix match
18549 path_len : length match
18550 path_reg : regex match
18551 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018552
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018553pathq : string
18554 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18555 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18556 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18557 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18558 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18559 result in both cases.
18560
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018561query : string
18562 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18563 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18564 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18565 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018566 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018567 which stops before the question mark.
18568
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018569req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18570 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18571 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18572 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18573 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018575req.ver : string
18576req_ver : string (deprecated)
18577 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18578 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18579 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018581 ACL derivatives :
18582 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018583
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018584res.body : binary
18585 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18586 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18587 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18588 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18589
18590res.body_len : integer
18591 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18592 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18593 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18594 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18595
18596res.body_size : integer
18597 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18598 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18599 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18600 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18601 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18602 based expect rules.
18603
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018604res.cache_hit : boolean
18605 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18606 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18607
18608res.cache_name : string
18609 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18610 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18611 empty string.
18612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018613res.comp : boolean
18614 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18615 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18616 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018618res.comp_algo : string
18619 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18620 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18621 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018623res.cook([<name>]) : string
18624scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18625 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18626 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018627 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18628 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018630 ACL derivatives :
18631 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018633res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18634scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18635 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18636 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018637 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18638 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018640res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18641scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18642 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18643 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018644 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18645 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018647res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18648 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18649 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18650 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18651 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18652 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18653 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18654 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18655 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018656 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018658res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18659 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18660 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18661 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18662 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018663 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18664 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018666res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18667shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18668 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18669 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18670 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18671 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18672 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18673 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18674 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018675 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18676 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018678 ACL derivatives :
18679 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18680 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18681 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18682 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18683 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18684 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18685 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18686 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18687
18688res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18689shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18690 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18691 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18692 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18693 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018694 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018696res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18697shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18698 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18699 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18700 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18701 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18702 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018703 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18704 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018705
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018706res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18707 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18708 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18709 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018710 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18711 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018713res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18714shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18715 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18716 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18717 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18718 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18719 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018720 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18721 based expect rules.
18722
18723res.hdrs : string
18724 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18725 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18726 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18727 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18728 based expect rules.
18729
18730res.hdrs_bin : binary
18731 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18732 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18733 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18734 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18735 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18736 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18737 (length of 0 for both).
18738
18739 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18740
18741 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18742 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018744res.ver : string
18745resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18746 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018747 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18748 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018750 ACL derivatives :
18751 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018753set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18754 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18755 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018756 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018757 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18760 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018762status : integer
18763 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18764 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018765 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18766 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018767
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018768unique-id : string
18769 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18770 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18771 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18772 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18773 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18774 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018776url : string
18777 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18778 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18779 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18780 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18781 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18782 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18783 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018785 ACL derivatives :
18786 url : exact string match
18787 url_beg : prefix match
18788 url_dir : subdir match
18789 url_dom : domain match
18790 url_end : suffix match
18791 url_len : length match
18792 url_reg : regex match
18793 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018795url_ip : ip
18796 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18797 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18798 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18799 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18800 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18801 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18802 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018804url_port : integer
18805 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18806 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18807 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18808 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018809
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018810urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18811url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018812 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18813 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018814 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18815 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18816 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18817 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018818 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18819 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018820 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18821 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018823 ACL derivatives :
18824 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18825 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18826 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18827 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18828 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18829 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18830 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18831 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018832
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018834 Example :
18835 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18836 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18837 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18838 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018839
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018840urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018841 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18842 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18843 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018844
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018845url32 : integer
18846 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18847 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18848 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18849 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18850 is an unsigned integer.
18851
18852url32+src : binary
18853 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18854 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18855 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18856
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018857
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200188587.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018859---------------------------------------
18860
18861This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18862used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18863purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18864There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18865or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18866any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18867for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18868
18869internal.htx.data : integer
18870 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18871 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18872
18873internal.htx.free : integer
18874 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18875 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18876
18877internal.htx.free_data : integer
18878 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18879 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18880
18881internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18882 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18883 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18884 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18885
18886internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18887 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18888 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18889
18890internal.htx.size : integer
18891 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18892 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18893
18894internal.htx.used : integer
18895 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18896 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18897 direction.
18898
18899internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18900 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18901 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18902 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18903 of the special value :
18904 * head : The oldest inserted block
18905 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018906 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018907
18908internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18909 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18910 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18911 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18912 integer or one of the special value :
18913 * head : The oldest inserted block
18914 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018915 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018916
18917internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18918 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18919 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18920 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18921 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18922
18923 * head : The oldest inserted block
18924 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018925 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018926
18927internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18928 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18929 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18930 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18931 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18932
18933 * head : The oldest inserted block
18934 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018935 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018936
18937internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18938 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18939 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18940 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18941 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18942
18943 * head : The oldest inserted block
18944 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018945 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018946
18947internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18948 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18949 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18950 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18951 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18952
18953 * head : The oldest inserted block
18954 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018955 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018956
18957internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18958 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18959 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18960 it returns false.
18961
18962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200189637.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018964---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018966Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18967every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018968order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018970ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18971---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018972FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018973HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018974HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18975HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018976HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18977HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18978HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18979HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18980LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018981METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018982METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018983METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18984METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18985METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18986METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018987METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018988METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018989RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018990REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018991TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018992WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18993---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018994
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189968. Logging
18997----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018998
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018999One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19000provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19001very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19002provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19003state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019004to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019005headers.
19006
19007In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19008about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19009send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19010
19011 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19012 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19013 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19014 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19015 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019016 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019017 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019018
19019The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19020allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19021as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19022while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19023real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19024delay.
19025
19026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190278.1. Log levels
19028---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019029
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019030TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019031source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019032HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19033in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19034track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19035syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19036about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019037
19038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190398.2. Log formats
19040----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019041
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019042HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019043and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19044slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19045options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019046
19047 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19048 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19049 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19050 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19051 extents.
19052
19053 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19054 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19055 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19056 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19057 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19058
19059 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19060 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19061 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19062 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19063 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19064
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019065 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19066 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19067 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19068 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19069
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019070 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19071
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019072Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19073specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19074field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19075servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19076always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19077identifier.
19078
19079Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19080 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19081 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19082 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19083 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19084
19085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190868.2.1. Default log format
19087-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019088
19089This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19090as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19091format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19092
19093 Example :
19094 listen www
19095 mode http
19096 log global
19097 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19098
19099 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19100 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19101 (www/HTTP)
19102
19103 Field Format Extract from the example above
19104 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19105 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19106 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19107 4 'to' to
19108 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19109 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19110
19111Detailed fields description :
19112 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19113 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19114 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19115 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19116 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19117 and processed the connection.
19118 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19119
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019120In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19121"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19122connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19123
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019124It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19125will eventually disappear.
19126
19127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191288.2.2. TCP log format
19129---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019130
19131The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19132is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19133information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19134counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19135emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19136environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19137the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19138sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019139specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19140not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19141fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19142marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019143
19144 Example :
19145 frontend fnt
19146 mode tcp
19147 option tcplog
19148 log global
19149 default_backend bck
19150
19151 backend bck
19152 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19153
19154 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19155 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19156 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19157
19158 Field Format Extract from the example above
19159 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19160 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19161 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19162 4 frontend_name fnt
19163 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19164 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19165 7 bytes_read* 212
19166 8 termination_state --
19167 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19168 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19169
19170Detailed fields description :
19171 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019172 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19173 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19174 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019175 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019176 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019177 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019178
19179 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019180 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19181 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19182 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019183
19184 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19185 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19186 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019187 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19188 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19189 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19190 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019191
19192 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19193 and processed the connection.
19194
19195 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19196 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19197 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19198 applications.
19199
19200 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19201 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19202 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19203 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19204 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19205
19206 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19207 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19208 See "Timers" below for more details.
19209
19210 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19211 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19212 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19213 "Timers" below for more details.
19214
19215 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019216 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019217 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19218 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19219 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19220 details.
19221
19222 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19223 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19224 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19225 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19226 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19227
19228 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19229 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19230 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19231 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19232 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19233 for more details.
19234
19235 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019236 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019237 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19238 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19239 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019240 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019241
19242 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19243 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19244 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19245 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19246 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19247 caused by a denial of service attack.
19248
19249 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19250 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19251 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19252 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19253 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19254 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19255 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19256 denial of service attack.
19257
19258 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19259 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19260 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19261 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19262 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19263 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19264 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19265 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19266 be processed than on other servers.
19267
19268 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19269 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19270 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19271 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19272 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19273 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19274 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19275 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19276 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19277 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19278 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19279 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19280 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19281
19282 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19283 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19284 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19285 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19286 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19287 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019288 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019289 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19290
19291 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19292 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19293 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19294 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19295 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19296 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019297 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019298 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19299 occurs.
19300
19301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193028.2.3. HTTP log format
19303----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019304
19305The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19306is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19307the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19308are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19309emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19310generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19311"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19312which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019313frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19314is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019315
19316Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19317slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19318with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19319
19320 Example :
19321 frontend http-in
19322 mode http
19323 option httplog
19324 log global
19325 default_backend bck
19326
19327 backend static
19328 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19329
19330 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19331 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19332 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019333 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019334
19335 Field Format Extract from the example above
19336 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19337 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019338 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019339 4 frontend_name http-in
19340 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019341 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019342 7 status_code 200
19343 8 bytes_read* 2750
19344 9 captured_request_cookie -
19345 10 captured_response_cookie -
19346 11 termination_state ----
19347 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19348 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19349 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19350 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19351 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019352
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019353Detailed fields description :
19354 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019355 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19356 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19357 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019358 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019359 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019360 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019361
19362 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019363 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19364 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19365 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019366
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019367 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19368 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019369
19370 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19371 and processed the connection.
19372
19373 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19374 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19375 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19376
19377 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19378 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19379 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19380 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19381 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19382 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19383
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019384 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19385 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19386 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019387 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019388 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19389 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019390 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19391 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019392
19393 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19394 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019395 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019396
19397 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19398 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019399 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19400 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019401
19402 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19403 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19404 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19405 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19406 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019407 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19408 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019409
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019410 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19411 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19412 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19413 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19414 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19415 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19416 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019417 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019418
19419 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19420 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19421 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19422
19423 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19424 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019425 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019426 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19427 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19428 overflowing.
19429
19430 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19431 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19432 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19433 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19434 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19435 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19436 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19437 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19438
19439 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19440 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19441 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19442 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19443 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19444 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19445 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19446 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19447
19448 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19449 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19450 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19451 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19452 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19453 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19454 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19455
19456 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019457 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019458 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19459 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19460 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019461 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019462 system.
19463
19464 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19465 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19466 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19467 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19468 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19469 caused by a denial of service attack.
19470
19471 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19472 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19473 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19474 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19475 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19476 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19477 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19478 denial of service attack.
19479
19480 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19481 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19482 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19483 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19484 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19485 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19486 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19487 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19488 processed than on other servers.
19489
19490 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19491 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19492 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19493 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19494 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19495 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19496 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19497 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19498 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19499 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19500 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19501 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19502 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19503
19504 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19505 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19506 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19507 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19508 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19509 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019510 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019511 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19512
19513 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19514 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19515 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19516 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19517 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19518 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019519 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019520 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19521 occurs.
19522
19523 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19524 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19525 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19526 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19527 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19528 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19529 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19530 cookies" below for more details.
19531
19532 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19533 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19534 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19535 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19536 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19537 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19538 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19539 and cookies" below for more details.
19540
19541 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19542 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19543 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19544 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19545 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19546 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19547 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19548 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19549
19550
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200195518.2.4. Custom log format
19552------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019553
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019554The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019555mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019556
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019557HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019558Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19559separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19560prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19561
19562Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19563variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019564("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019565
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019566If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019567as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019568less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19569the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19570
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019571Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19572"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19573delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19574preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019575
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019576Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19577'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19578https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19579such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19580
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019581Flags are :
19582 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019583 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019584 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19585 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019586
19587 Example:
19588
19589 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19591
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019592 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19593
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019594At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19595
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019596 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19597 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019598
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019599the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019600
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019601 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19602 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19603 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019604
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019605and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19606
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019607 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19608 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019609
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019610Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19611
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019612 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019613 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019614 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19615 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19616 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019617 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19618 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19619 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019620 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019621 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019622 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019623 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019624 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19625 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019626 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019627 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019628 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019629 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019630 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019631 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019632 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019633 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19634 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19635 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19636 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19637 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019638 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019639 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019640 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019641 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019642 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019643 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19644 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019645 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19646 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19647 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019648 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019649 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19650 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019651 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019652 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19653 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19654 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019655 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019656 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019657 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19658 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19659 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19660 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019661 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019662 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019663 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019664 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019665 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019666 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019667 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19668 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19669 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019670 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019671 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19672 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019673 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019674 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19675 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019676 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019677 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019678 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019679 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019680
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019681 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019682
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019683
196848.2.5. Error log format
19685-----------------------
19686
19687When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19688protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19689By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19690"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019691will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019692logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19693
19694The format looks like this :
19695
19696 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19697 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19698 Connection error during SSL handshake
19699
19700 Field Format Extract from the example above
19701 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19702 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19703 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19704 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19705 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19706
19707These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19708failures.
19709
19710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197118.3. Advanced logging options
19712-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019713
19714Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19715just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19716options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19717for more information about their usage.
19718
19719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197208.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19721------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019722
19723It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19724haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19725commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19726monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19727ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19728
19729 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19730 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19731 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19732 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19733
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019734 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19735 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019736
19737 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19738 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19739 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19740
19741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197428.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19743----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019744
19745The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19746what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19747or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019748"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019749just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19750log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19751after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19752is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19753with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19754with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19755
19756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197578.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19758------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019759
19760Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19761for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19762"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19763retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19764raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19765a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19766file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19767you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19768"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19769
19770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197718.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19772--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019773
19774Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19775multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19776them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19777"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19778logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19779error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19780and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19781too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19782useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19783alternative.
19784
19785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197868.4. Timing events
19787------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019788
19789Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19790reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19791the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19792frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019793mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19794addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19795
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019796Timings events in HTTP mode:
19797
19798 first request 2nd request
19799 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19800 t tr t tr ...
19801 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19802 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19803 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19804 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019805 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019806 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19807
19808Timings events in TCP mode:
19809
19810 TCP session
19811 |<----------------->|
19812 t t
19813 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19814 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19815 |<------ Tt ------->|
19816
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019817 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019818 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019819 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19820 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19821 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019822 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019823 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19824 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19825 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19826 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019827
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019828 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19829 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19830 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019831 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19832 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19833 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19834 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19835 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19836 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019837
19838 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19839 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19840 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19841 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19842 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19843 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19844 request typed by hand during a test.
19845
19846 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19847 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019848 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019849 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19850 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19851 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19852 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019853
19854 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19855 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19856 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19857 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19858 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19859
19860 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19861 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19862 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19863 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19864 connection never established.
19865
19866 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19867 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19868 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19869 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19870 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19871 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19872 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19873 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19874 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19875 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19876 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19877
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019878 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19879 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19880 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19881 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19882 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19883 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19884
19885 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19886
19887 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19888 "Ta" can never be negative.
19889
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019890 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19891 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019892 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19893 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019894 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019895
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019896 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019897
19898 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019899 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19900 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019901
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019902 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19903 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19904 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19905 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19906 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19907 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19908 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19909 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19910
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019911These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19912protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19913that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019914due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19915"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19916that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019917
19918Most common cases :
19919
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019920 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19921 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19922 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19923 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19924 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19925 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19926 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19927 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19928 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19929 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19930 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019931 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019932
19933 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19934 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19935 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19936 of ms on remote networks.
19937
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019938 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19939 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19940 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019941
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019942 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19943 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19944 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19945 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19946 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19947 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19948 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19949 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19950 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019951
19952Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19953
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019954 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019955 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019956 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019957
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019958 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019959 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19960 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19961
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019962 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019963 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19964 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19965 flags.
19966
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019967 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19968 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019969 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19970 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19971 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19972 the client connection was maintained open.
19973
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019974 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019975 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019976 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019977 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19978
19979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199808.5. Session state at disconnection
19981-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019982
19983TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19984"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
199852-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19986each of which has a special meaning :
19987
19988 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19989 session to terminate :
19990
19991 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19992
19993 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19994 server explicitly refused it.
19995
19996 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19997 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19998 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19999 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020000 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020001
20002 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20003 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020004
20005 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20006 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20007 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20008 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20009 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20010
20011 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20012 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20013 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20014 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20015 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20016
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020017 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20018 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20019
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020020 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20021 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20022 backup connections when going up.
20023
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020024 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20025
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020026 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20027 send or receive data.
20028
20029 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20030 send or receive data.
20031
20032 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20033 with nothing left in the buffers.
20034
20035 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20036
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020037 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020038 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20039
20040 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20041 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20042 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20043 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20044 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20045
20046 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20047 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20048
20049 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20050 server (HTTP only).
20051
20052 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20053
20054 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20055 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20056 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20057
20058 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20059 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20060 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20061
20062 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20063
20064 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20065 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20066
20067 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20068 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20069 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20070
20071 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20072 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020073 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20074 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020075
20076 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20077 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20078 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20079 another server.
20080
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020081 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020082 server.
20083
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020084 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20085 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20086 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20087 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20088
20089 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20090 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20091 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20092 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20093
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020094 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20095 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20096 "use-server" rule).
20097
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020098 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20099
20100 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20101 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20102
20103 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20104
20105 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20106 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20107 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20108
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020109 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20110 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020111 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020112 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20113 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20114
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020115 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20116
20117 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20118 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20119
20120 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20121
20122 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20123
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020124The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20125was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020126helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20127starvation, attacks, etc...
20128
20129The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20130alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20131easier finding and understanding.
20132
20133 Flags Reason
20134
20135 -- Normal termination.
20136
20137 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20138 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20139 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20140 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20141
20142 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20143 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20144 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20145 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20146 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20147 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020148
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020149 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20150 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020151 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020152
20153 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20154 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20155 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20156
20157 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20158 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20159 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20160 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20161 the server takes too long to respond.
20162
20163 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20164 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20165 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20166 long a time to respond.
20167
20168 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20169 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20170 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20171 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020172 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20173 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020174
20175 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20176 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20177 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20178 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20179 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020180 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020181 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20182 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20183 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20184 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20185 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20186 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20187 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20188 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020189 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020190 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20191 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20192 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020193
20194 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20195 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020196 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20197 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20198 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20199 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020200
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020201 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20202 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020204 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020205 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20206 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020207 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020208 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20209 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20210
20211 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20212 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20213 503 or 504 here.
20214
20215 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20216 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20217 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20218 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20219 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20220
20221 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20222 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020223 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020224 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20225 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20226
20227 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20228 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20229 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20230 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20231 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20232 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20233 between haproxy and the server.
20234
20235 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20236 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20237 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20238 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20239 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20240 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20241 solution is to fix the application.
20242
20243 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20244 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20245 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20246 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20247 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20248 external attacks.
20249
20250 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
20251 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020252 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020253 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20254 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20255
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020256 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20257 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20258 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020259 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020260 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020261
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020262 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20263 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20264 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20265 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020266 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20267 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20268 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20269 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20270 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020271
20272 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20273 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20274 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20275 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20276
20277 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20278 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20279 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20280 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20281
20282 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20283 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20284 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20285 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20286
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020287The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20288persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20289important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20290re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20291
20292 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20293
20294 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20295 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20296 set on a GET request.
20297
20298 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20299 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020300 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020301 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20302
20303 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20304 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20305 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20306
20307 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20308 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20309 already got a cookie.
20310
20311 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20312 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20313 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20314 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20315 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20316
20317 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20318 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20319 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20320
20321 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20322 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20323 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20324
20325 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20326 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20327
20328 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20329 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20330 then advertised in the response.
20331
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203338.6. Non-printable characters
20334-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020335
20336In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20337consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20338converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20339prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20340being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20341escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20342is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20343'}' when logging headers.
20344
20345Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20346issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20347containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20348
20349Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20350the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20351performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20352
20353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203548.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20355---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020356
20357Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20358achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020359section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020360cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20361the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20362the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020363locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020364not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20365user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20366a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20367wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20368
20369 Examples :
20370 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20371 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20372
20373 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20374 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20375
20376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203778.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20378---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020379
20380Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20381proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20382the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20383server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20384
20385Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20386response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020387section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020388
20389It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020390time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20391appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020392are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20393and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20394follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20395request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20396in the logs.
20397
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020398As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20399frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20400an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20401
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020402 Example :
20403 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20404 listen proxy-out
20405 mode http
20406 option httplog
20407 option logasap
20408 log global
20409 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20410
20411 # log the name of the virtual server
20412 capture request header Host len 20
20413
20414 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20415 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20416
20417 # log the beginning of the referrer
20418 capture request header Referer len 20
20419
20420 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20421 capture response header Server len 20
20422
20423 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20424 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20425
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020426 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020427 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20428
20429 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20430 capture response header Via len 20
20431
20432 # log the URL location during a redirection
20433 capture response header Location len 20
20434
20435 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20436 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20437 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20438 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20439 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20440
20441 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20442 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20443 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20444 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020445 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020446
20447 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20448 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20449 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20450 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20451 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020452 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020453
20454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204558.9. Examples of logs
20456---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020457
20458These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20459them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20460reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20461
20462 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20463 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20464 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20465
20466 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20467 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20468
20469 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20470 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20471 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20472
20473 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20474 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20475
20476 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20477 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20478 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20479
20480 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020481 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020482 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20483 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20484
20485 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20486 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20487 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20488
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020489 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20490 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20491 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20492 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20493 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20494 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020495
20496 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020497 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020498
20499 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20500 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20501 Nothing was sent to any server.
20502
20503 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20504 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20505
20506 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20507 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020508 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020509 send a 408 return code to the client.
20510
20511 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20512 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20513
20514 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20515 5 seconds ("c----").
20516
20517 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20518 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020519 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020520
20521 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020522 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020523 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20524 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20525 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20526 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20527 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020528
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020529
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200205309. Supported filters
20531--------------------
20532
20533Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20534accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20535unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20536
20537See also : "filter"
20538
205399.1. Trace
20540----------
20541
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020542filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020543
20544 Arguments:
20545 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20546 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20547
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020548 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020549
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020550 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020551 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20552 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20553 amount of the parsed data.
20554
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020555 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020556
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020557This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20558callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20559information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20560filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20561
20562Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20563tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20564a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20565
20566
205679.2. HTTP compression
20568---------------------
20569
20570filter compression
20571
20572The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20573keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020574when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20575fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20576done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20577explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20578filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20579listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20580order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020581
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020582See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20583 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020584
20585
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200205869.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20587--------------------------------------------
20588
20589filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20590
20591 Arguments :
20592
20593 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20594 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20595 parsed.
20596
20597 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20598 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20599 part must be placed in its own scope.
20600
20601The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20602external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020603streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020604exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20605also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20606
20607SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20608the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20609
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020610For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020611"doc/SPOE.txt".
20612
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100206139.4. Cache
20614----------
20615
20616filter cache <name>
20617
20618 Arguments :
20619
20620 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20621
20622The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20623"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020624cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020625other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20626case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20627is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20628filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020629listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20630order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020631
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020632See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20633 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20634
20635
206369.5. Fcgi-app
20637-------------
20638
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020639filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020640
20641 Arguments :
20642
20643 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20644
20645The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20646request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20647reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20648used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20649implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20650used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20651fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20652used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20653order.
20654
20655See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20656 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20657
20658
2065910. FastCGI applications
20660-------------------------
20661
20662HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20663feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20664the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20665FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20666servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20667FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20668backend.
20669
20670HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20671application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20672connection.
20673
2067410.1. Setup
20675-----------
20676
2067710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20678--------------------------
20679
20680fcgi-app <name>
20681 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20682 document root must be defined.
20683
20684acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20685 Declare or complete an access list.
20686
20687 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20688 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20689 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20690 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20691 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20692
20693docroot <path>
20694 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20695 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20696 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20697
20698index <script-name>
20699 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20700 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20701 is an optional setting.
20702
20703 Example :
20704 index index.php
20705
20706log-stderr global
20707log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20708 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20709 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20710
20711 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20712 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20713
20714pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20715 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20716 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20717 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20718
20719 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20720 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20721 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20722 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20723
20724 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20725 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20726
20727path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020728 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020729 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20730 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20731 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20732 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20733 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20734 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20735 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020736
20737 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020738 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020739 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20740 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20741 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20742 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020743
20744 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020745 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20746 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020747
20748option get-values
20749no option get-values
20750 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20751
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020752 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020753 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20754
20755 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20756 application will accept.
20757
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020758 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20759 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020760
20761 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020762 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020763 option is disabled.
20764
20765 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20766 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20767 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20768 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20769 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20770 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20771
20772option keep-conn
20773no option keep-conn
20774 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20775 sending a response.
20776
20777 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20778 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20779
20780option max-reqs <reqs>
20781 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20782 accept.
20783
20784 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20785 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20786 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20787 to 1.
20788
20789option mpxs-conns
20790no option mpxs-conns
20791 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20792
20793 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20794 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20795
20796set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20797 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20798 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20799 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20800 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20801
20802 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20803 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20804 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20805
20806 Example :
20807 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20808 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20809
20810 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20811
20812
2081310.1.2. Proxy section
20814---------------------
20815
20816use-fcgi-app <name>
20817 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20818
20819 Arguments :
20820 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20821
20822 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20823 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20824 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20825 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20826 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20827
20828 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20829 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20830 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20831 application are evaluated.
20832
20833
2083410.1.3. Example
20835---------------
20836
20837 frontend front-http
20838 mode http
20839 bind *:80
20840 bind *:
20841
20842 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20843 default_backend back-static
20844
20845 backend back-static
20846 mode http
20847 server www A.B.C.D:80
20848
20849 backend back-dynamic
20850 mode http
20851 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20852 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20853
20854 fcgi-app php-fpm
20855 log-stderr global
20856 option keep-conn
20857
20858 docroot /var/www/my-app
20859 index index.php
20860 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20861
20862
2086310.2. Default parameters
20864------------------------
20865
20866A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20867the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020868script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020869applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20870
20871 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20872 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20873 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20874 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20875 | | |
20876 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20877 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20878 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20879 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20880 | | application. |
20881 | | |
20882 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20883 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20884 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20885 | | |
20886 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20887 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20888 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20889 | | the application's configuration. |
20890 | | |
20891 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20892 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20893 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20894 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20895 | | |
20896 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20897 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20898 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20899 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20900 | | be defined. |
20901 | | |
20902 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20903 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20904 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20905 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20906 | | is not set too. |
20907 | | |
20908 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20909 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20910 | | set. |
20911 | | |
20912 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20913 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20914 | | the request. |
20915 | | |
20916 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20917 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20918 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20919 | | |
20920 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20921 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20922 | | script to process the request. |
20923 | | |
20924 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20925 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20926 | | |
20927 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20928 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20929 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20930 | | |
20931 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20932 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20933 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20934 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20935 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20936 | | |
20937 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20938 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20939 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20940 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20941 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20942 | | side. |
20943 | | |
20944 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20945 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20946 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20947 | | connected to. |
20948 | | |
20949 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20950 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20951 | | |
20952 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20953 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20954 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20955 | | |
20956 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20957
20958
2095910.3. Limitations
20960------------------
20961
20962The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20963way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20964during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20965establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20966application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20967or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20968message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20969these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20970and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20971
20972Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20973request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20974requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20975
20976About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20977into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20978fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20979"http-request" ones.
20980
20981Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20982FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20983processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20984must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20985here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020987/*
20988 * Local variables:
20989 * fill-column: 79
20990 * End:
20991 */